]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi
re PR debug/77985 (DW_AT_comp_dir is omitted when filename is absolute and the file...
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56 * Misc:: Everything else.
57 @end menu
58
59 @node Target Structure
60 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61 @cindex target hooks
62 @cindex target functions
63
64 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72 @smallexample
73 #include "target.h"
74 #include "target-def.h"
75
76 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
78 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82 @end smallexample
83 @end deftypevar
84
85 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89 @code{targetm} structure.
90
91 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107 default definition is used.
108
109 @node Driver
110 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111 @cindex driver
112 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
115 You can control the compilation driver.
116
117 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130 that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133 @end defmac
134
135 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145 everywhere it occurs.
146
147 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152 @end defmac
153
154 @defmac CPP_SPEC
155 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160 @end defmac
161
162 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166 @end defmac
167
168 @defmac CC1_SPEC
169 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171 front ends.
172 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173 for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176 @end defmac
177
178 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
181 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187 @end defmac
188
189 @defmac ASM_SPEC
190 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
192 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202 an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218 @end defmac
219
220 @defmac LINK_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
223 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226 @end defmac
227
228 @defmac LIB_SPEC
229 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231 command given to the linker.
232
233 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245 @end defmac
246
247 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
253 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
262 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380 The default value of this macro is empty string.
381 @end defmac
382
383 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
384 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
389 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
391 @end defmac
392
393 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395 @end deftypevr
396
397 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
398 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406 @xref{Target Fragment}.
407 @end defmac
408
409 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
410 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
411 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
412 indicates an absolute file name.
413 @end defmac
414
415 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
416 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
418 when the compiler is built as a cross
419 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
420 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
421 @end defmac
422
423 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
424 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
425 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
426 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
427 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428 is built as a cross compiler.
429 @end defmac
430
431 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436 is built as a cross compiler.
437 @end defmac
438
439 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444 is built as a cross compiler.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
448 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
450 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451 @end defmac
452
453 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
454 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
455 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456 cross compiler.
457 @end defmac
458
459 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
460 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
461 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463 initialize the necessary environment variables.
464 @end defmac
465
466 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
467 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
470 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
472
473 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474 replacement.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
479 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
481 @end defmac
482
483 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
484 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
485 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
487 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
489 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
490 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
491 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
494 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
495 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496 for C++-only directories,
497 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499 the array with a null element.
500
501 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
502 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
503 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
504 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
506 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
507
508 @smallexample
509 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510 @{ \
511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
516 @}
517 @end smallexample
518 @end defmac
519
520 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522 @enumerate
523 @item
524 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
525
526 @item
527 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
528 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
529 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
530
531 @item
532 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534 @item
535 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
536 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544 @item
545 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
546 compiler.
547 @end enumerate
548
549 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551 @enumerate
552 @item
553 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
554
555 @item
556 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557 value based on the installed toolchain location.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
561 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
562
563 @item
564 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
565 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
572 compiler.
573
574 @item
575 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
576 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
580 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/lib/}.
591
592 @item
593 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
595 @file{/usr/lib/}.
596 @end enumerate
597
598 @node Run-time Target
599 @section Run-time Target Specification
600 @cindex run-time target specification
601 @cindex predefined macros
602 @cindex target specifications
603
604 @c prevent bad page break with this line
605 Here are run-time target specifications.
606
607 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
608 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
609 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
610 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
611 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
612 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613 finished command line option processing your code can use those
614 results freely.
615
616 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
618 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
619 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
621 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
622 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
623 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
624 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
632 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
637 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
638 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640 preprocessing.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target operating system instead.
646 @end defmac
647
648 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
649 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652 it yourself.
653 @end defmac
654
655 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
656 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657 any target-specific headers.
658 @end deftypevar
659
660 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
661 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662 Its default setting is 0.
663 @end deftypevr
664
665 @cindex optional hardware or system features
666 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
668 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
669 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673 definition does nothing but return true.
674
675 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679 via attributes).
680 @end deftypefn
681
682 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
683 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
687 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688 default definition does nothing but return false.
689
690 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694 @end deftypefn
695
696 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
697 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698 @end deftypefn
699
700 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702 @end deftypefn
703
704 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706 @end deftypefn
707
708 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
709 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710 @end deftypefn
711
712 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
713 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
714 @end deftypefn
715
716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
717 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
718 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
721 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
723 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724 @end deftypefn
725
726 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
727 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728 but is only used in the C
729 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731 frontends.
732 @end defmac
733
734 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
735 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
736 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738 options are processed once
739 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
740 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
741 options passed explicitly.
742
743 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
744 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745 @code{optimize} attribute.
746 @end deftypevr
747
748 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
749 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
753 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754 @end deftypefn
755
756 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772 is 0.
773 @end defmac
774
775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777 @end deftypefn
778
779 @node Per-Function Data
780 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781 @cindex per-function data
782 @cindex data structures
783
784 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788 when another one comes along.
789
790 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794 to their own specific data.
795
796 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
797 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
800
801 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804 function, for level 0.
805
806 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
807 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
811 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
812 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814 longer supported.
815
816 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
817 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
818 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
819 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
820 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821 @end defmac
822
823 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
829
830 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
831 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
832 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
833 @end deftypevar
834
835 @node Storage Layout
836 @section Storage Layout
837 @cindex storage layout
838
839 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842 @xref{Run-time Target}.
843
844 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
845 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850 macro need not be a constant.
851
852 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
857 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
864 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
866 macro need not be a constant.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873 the order of words in memory.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
877 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883 multi-word integers.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
906 @end defmac
907
908 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
909 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
913 @end defmac
914
915 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
925 @end defmac
926
927 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931 scalar type.
932
933 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938 counterparts.
939
940 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
948 @end defmac
949
950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
951 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
952 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
953 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
954 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
955 pointer} types.
956
957 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
958 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
959 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
960 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
961 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
962 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
963 the signedness may be different.
964
965 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
966
967 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
968 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
969 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
970 @end deftypefn
971
972 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
973 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
974 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
975 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
976 size of an integer.
977 @end defmac
978
979 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
980 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
981 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
982 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
983 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
984 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
985 @end defmac
986
987 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
988 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
989 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
990 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
991 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
992 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
993 @end defmac
994
995 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
996 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
997 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
998 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
999 @end defmac
1000
1001 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1002 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1003 @end defmac
1004
1005 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1006 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1007 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1008 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1009 @end defmac
1010
1011 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1012 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1013 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1014 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1015 @end deftypevr
1016
1017 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1018 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1019 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1020 @end defmac
1021
1022 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1023 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1024 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1025 @end defmac
1026
1027 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1028 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1029 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1030 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1031 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1032 @end defmac
1033
1034 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1035 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1036 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1037 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1038 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1039 @end defmac
1040
1041 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1042 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1043 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1044 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1045 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1046 field alignment has not been set by the
1047 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1048 @end defmac
1049
1050 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1051 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1052 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1053
1054 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1055
1056 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1057 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1058 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1059 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1060 @end defmac
1061
1062 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1063 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1064 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1065 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1066 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1067
1068 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1069 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1070 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1071 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1072 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1073 @end defmac
1074
1075 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1076 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1077 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1078 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1079 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1080
1081 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1082
1083 @findex strcpy
1084 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1085 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1086 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1087 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1088 @end defmac
1089
1090 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1091 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1092 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1093 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1094 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1095
1096 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1097 @end defmac
1098
1099 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1100 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1101 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1102 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1103 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1104 align the object.
1105
1106 The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
1107
1108 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1109 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1110 constants can be done inline.
1111 @end defmac
1112
1113 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1114 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1115 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1116 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1117 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1118
1119 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1120
1121 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1123
1124 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1125 @end defmac
1126
1127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1128 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1129 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1130 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1131 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1132 the vector element type.
1133 @end deftypefn
1134
1135 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1136 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1137 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1138 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1139 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1140 align the slot.
1141
1142 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1143 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1144 be used.
1145
1146 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1147 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1148
1149 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1150 @end defmac
1151
1152 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1153 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1154 variable @var{decl}.
1155
1156 If this macro is not defined, then
1157 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1158 is used.
1159
1160 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1161 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1162
1163 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1164 @end defmac
1165
1166 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1167 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1168 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1169 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1170
1171 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1172 @end defmac
1173
1174 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1175 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1176 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1177
1178 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1179 @end defmac
1180
1181 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1182 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1183 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1184
1185 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1186 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1187 @end defmac
1188
1189 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1190 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1191 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1192 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1193 @end defmac
1194
1195 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1196 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1197 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1198
1199 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1200 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1201 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1202 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1203 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1204
1205 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1206 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1207 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1208 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1209
1210 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1211 structure.
1212
1213 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1214 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1215
1216 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1217 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1218 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1219 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1220
1221 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1222 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1223 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1224
1225 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1226 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1227 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1228
1229 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1230 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1231 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1232
1233 @smallexample
1234 struct foo1
1235 @{
1236 char x;
1237 char :0;
1238 char y;
1239 @};
1240
1241 struct foo2
1242 @{
1243 char x;
1244 int :0;
1245 char y;
1246 @};
1247
1248 main ()
1249 @{
1250 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1251 sizeof (struct foo1));
1252 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1253 sizeof (struct foo2));
1254 exit (0);
1255 @}
1256 @end smallexample
1257
1258 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1259 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1260 @end defmac
1261
1262 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1263 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1264 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1265 @end defmac
1266
1267 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1268 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1269 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1270 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1271 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1272 @end deftypefn
1273
1274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1275 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1276 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1277 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1278
1279 The default is @code{false}.
1280 @end deftypefn
1281
1282 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1283 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1284 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1285
1286 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1287 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1288 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1289 retain the field's mode.
1290
1291 Normally, this is not needed.
1292 @end deftypefn
1293
1294 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1295 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1296 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1297 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1298 @var{specified}.
1299
1300 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1301 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1302 @end defmac
1303
1304 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1305 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1306 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1307 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1308 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1309 (DImode)} is assumed.
1310 @end defmac
1311
1312 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1313 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1314 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1315 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1316 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1317 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1318 having its mode specified.
1319
1320 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1321 would most commonly define this macro if the
1322 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1323 64-bit mode.
1324 @end defmac
1325
1326 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1327 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1328 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1329 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1330
1331 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1332 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1333 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1334 @end defmac
1335
1336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1337 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1338 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1339 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1340 targets.
1341 @end deftypefn
1342
1343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1344 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1345 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1346 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1347 targets.
1348 @end deftypefn
1349
1350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1351 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1352 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1353 @end deftypefn
1354
1355 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1356 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1357 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1358 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1359 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1360 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1361 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1362 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1363 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1364 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1365 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1366 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1367
1368 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1369 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1370 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1371 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1372 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1373 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1374 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1375
1376 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1377 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1378 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1379 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1380 may affect its placement.
1381 @end deftypefn
1382
1383 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1384 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1392 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1393 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1394 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1395 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1396 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1397 usage.
1398 @end deftypefn
1399
1400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1401 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1402 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1403 @end deftypefn
1404
1405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1406 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1407 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1408 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1409 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1410 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1411 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1412 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1413 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1414 string constant.
1415
1416 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1417 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1418 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1419 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1420 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1421 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1422 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1423 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1424 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1425 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1426 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1427 spaces in your string.
1428
1429 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1430 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1431 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1432 before mangling.
1433
1434 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1435 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1436 types.
1437 @end deftypefn
1438
1439 @node Type Layout
1440 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1441
1442 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1443 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1444 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1445 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1446
1447 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1448 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1449 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1450 @end defmac
1451
1452 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1453 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1454 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1455 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1456 unit.)
1457 @end defmac
1458
1459 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1460 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1461 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462 @end defmac
1463
1464 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1465 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1466 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1467 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1468 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1469 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1470 @end defmac
1471
1472 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1473 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1474 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1475 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1476 macro must be at least 64.
1477 @end defmac
1478
1479 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1480 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1481 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1482 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1483 @end defmac
1484
1485 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1486 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1487 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1488 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1493 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1494 @end defmac
1495
1496 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1497 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1498 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1499 words.
1500 @end defmac
1501
1502 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1503 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1504 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1505 words.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1510 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1546 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1548 @end defmac
1549
1550 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1552 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1557 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1558 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1559 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1560 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1561 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1562 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1563 @end defmac
1564
1565 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1566 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1567 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1568 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1569 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1570 @end defmac
1571
1572 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1573 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1574 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1575 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1576 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1577 is the default.
1578 @end defmac
1579
1580 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1581 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1582 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1583 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1584 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1585 @end defmac
1586
1587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1588 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1589 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1590 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1591 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1592
1593 The default is to return false.
1594 @end deftypefn
1595
1596 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1597 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1598 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1599 contents of the string.
1600
1601 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1602 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1603 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1604 of the data type names defined in the function
1605 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1606 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1607 compiler to crash on startup.
1608
1609 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1610 int"}.
1611 @end defmac
1612
1613 @defmac SIZETYPE
1614 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1615 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1616 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1617 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1618 is extracted.
1619
1620 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1621
1622 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1623 @end defmac
1624
1625 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1626 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1627 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1628 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1629 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1630
1631 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1632 @end defmac
1633
1634 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1635 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1636 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1637 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1638 information.
1639
1640 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1641 @end defmac
1642
1643 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1644 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1645 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1646 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1647 @end defmac
1648
1649 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1650 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1651 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1652 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1653 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1654 information.
1655
1656 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1657 @end defmac
1658
1659 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1660 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1661 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1662 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1663 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1664
1665 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1666 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1667 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1668 @end defmac
1669
1670 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1671 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1672 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1673 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1674 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1675
1676 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1677 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1678 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1679 int}.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1683 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1684 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1685 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1686 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1687 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1688 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1689 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1690 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1691 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1692 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1693 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1694 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1695 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1696 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1697 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1698 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1699 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1700 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1701 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1702 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1704 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1705 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1706 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1707 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1709 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1710 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1711 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1712 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1713 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1714 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1715 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1716 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1717 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1718 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1719
1720 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1721 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1722 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1723 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1724 these macros are null pointers.
1725 @end defmac
1726
1727 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1728 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1729 that looks like:
1730
1731 @smallexample
1732 struct @{
1733 union @{
1734 void (*fn)();
1735 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1736 @};
1737 ptrdiff_t delta;
1738 @};
1739 @end smallexample
1740
1741 @noindent
1742 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1743 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1744 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1745 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1746 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1747 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1748 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1749 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1750
1751 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1752 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1753 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1754 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1755 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1756 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1757 architecture, you should define this macro to
1758 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1759
1760 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1761 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1762 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1763 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1764 @end defmac
1765
1766 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1767 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1768 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1769 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1770 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1771 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1772 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1773
1774 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1775 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1776 @end defmac
1777
1778 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1779 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1780 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1781 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1782 when special alignment is necessary. */
1783 @end defmac
1784
1785 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1786 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1787 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1788 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1789 of words in each data entry.
1790 @end defmac
1791
1792 @node Registers
1793 @section Register Usage
1794 @cindex register usage
1795
1796 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1797 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1798
1799 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1800 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1801 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1802 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1803 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1804
1805 @menu
1806 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1807 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1808 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1809 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1810 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1811 @end menu
1812
1813 @node Register Basics
1814 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1815
1816 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1817 Registers have various characteristics.
1818
1819 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1820 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1821 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1822 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1823 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1824 @end defmac
1825
1826 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1827 @cindex fixed register
1828 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1829 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1830 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1831 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1832 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1833 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1834 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1835
1836 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1837 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1838 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1839
1840 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1841 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1842 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1843 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1844 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1845 @end defmac
1846
1847 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1848 @cindex call-used register
1849 @cindex call-clobbered register
1850 @cindex call-saved register
1851 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1852 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1853 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1854 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1855 function calls.
1856
1857 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1858 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1859 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1860 @end defmac
1861
1862 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1863 @cindex call-used register
1864 @cindex call-clobbered register
1865 @cindex call-saved register
1866 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1867 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1868 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1869 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1870 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1871 @end defmac
1872
1873 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1874 @cindex call-used register
1875 @cindex call-clobbered register
1876 @cindex call-saved register
1877 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1878 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1879 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1880 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1881 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1882 @end defmac
1883
1884 @findex fixed_regs
1885 @findex call_used_regs
1886 @findex global_regs
1887 @findex reg_names
1888 @findex reg_class_contents
1889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1890 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1891 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1892 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1893 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1894 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1895 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1896 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1897 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1898 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1899 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1900 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1901 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1902 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1903 command options have been applied.
1904
1905 @cindex disabling certain registers
1906 @cindex controlling register usage
1907 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1908 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1909 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1910 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1911 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1912 that shouldn't be used.
1913
1914 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1915 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1916 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1917 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1918 @end deftypefn
1919
1920 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1921 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1922 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1923 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1924 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1925 outbound register.
1926 @end defmac
1927
1928 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1929 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1930 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1931 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1932 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1933 register.
1934 @end defmac
1935
1936 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1937 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1938 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1939 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1940 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1941 gotos.
1942 @end defmac
1943
1944 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1945 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1946 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1947 @end defmac
1948
1949 @node Allocation Order
1950 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1951 @cindex order of register allocation
1952 @cindex register allocation order
1953
1954 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1955 Registers are allocated in order.
1956
1957 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1958 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1959 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1960 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1961
1962 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1963 (all else being equal).
1964
1965 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1966 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1967 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1968 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1969 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1970 @end defmac
1971
1972 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1974 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1975
1976 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1977 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1978 register; and so on.
1979
1980 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1981 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1982
1983 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1984 @end defmac
1985
1986 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1987 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1988 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1989 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1990 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1991 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1992 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
1993 @end defmac
1994
1995 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1996 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1997 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1998 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1999 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2000 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2001 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2002 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2003
2004 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005 @end defmac
2006
2007 @node Values in Registers
2008 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2009
2010 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2011 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2012 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2013
2014 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2015 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2016 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2017 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2018 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2019 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2020
2021 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2022 definition of this macro is
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2026 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2027 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2028 @end smallexample
2029 @end defmac
2030
2031 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2033 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2034 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2035 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2036 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2037 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2038
2039 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2040 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2041 nonzero.
2042
2043 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2044 @code{subreg_get_info}
2045 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2046 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2047 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2048 registers and so not be representable.
2049 @end defmac
2050
2051 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2052 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2053 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2054 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2055 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2056 @end defmac
2057
2058 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2059 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2060 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2061 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2062 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2063 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2064 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2065 @end defmac
2066
2067 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2068 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2069 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2070 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2071 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2075 @end smallexample
2076
2077 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2078 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2079
2080 @cindex register pairs
2081 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2082 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2083 odd register numbers for such modes.
2084
2085 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2086 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2087 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2088 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2089
2090 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2091 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2092 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2093 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2094 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2095 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2096 to be tieable.
2097
2098 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2099 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2100 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2101 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2102 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2103 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2104
2105 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2106 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2107 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2108 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2109 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2110 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2111 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2112 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2113 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2114
2115 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2116 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2117 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2118 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2119 constraints for those instructions.
2120
2121 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2122 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2123 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2124 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2125 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2126 @end defmac
2127
2128 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2129 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2130 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2131
2132 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2133 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2134 handler.
2135
2136 The default is always nonzero.
2137 @end defmac
2138
2139 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2140 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2141 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2142
2143 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2144 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2145 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2146 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2147 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2148 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2149
2150 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2151 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2152 allocation.
2153 @end defmac
2154
2155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2156 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2157 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2158
2159 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2160 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2161
2162 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2163 @end deftypefn
2164
2165 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2166 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2167 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2168 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2169 @end defmac
2170
2171 @node Leaf Functions
2172 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2173
2174 @cindex leaf functions
2175 @cindex functions, leaf
2176 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2177 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2178 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2179 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2180 normally arrive.
2181
2182 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2183 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2184 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2185 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2186 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2187 functions''.
2188
2189 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2190 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2191 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2192 accomplish this.
2193
2194 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2195 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2196 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2197 function treatment.
2198
2199 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2200 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2201 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2202 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2203 in this vector.
2204
2205 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2206 the treatment of leaf functions.
2207 @end defmac
2208
2209 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2210 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2211 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2212
2213 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2214 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2215 will cause the compiler to abort.
2216
2217 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2218 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2219 this.
2220 @end defmac
2221
2222 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2223 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2224 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2225 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2226 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2227 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2228 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2229 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2230 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2231 functions which only use leaf registers.
2232 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2233 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2234 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2235 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2236 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2237
2238 @node Stack Registers
2239 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2240
2241 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2242 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2243 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2244 stack.
2245
2246 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2247 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2248 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2249 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2250 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2251 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2252 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2253
2254 @defmac STACK_REGS
2255 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2259 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2260 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2261 @end defmac
2262
2263 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2264 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2265 of the stack.
2266 @end defmac
2267
2268 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2269 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2270 the stack.
2271 @end defmac
2272
2273 @node Register Classes
2274 @section Register Classes
2275 @cindex register class definitions
2276 @cindex class definitions, register
2277
2278 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2279 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2280 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2281 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2282
2283 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2284 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2285 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2286
2287 @findex ALL_REGS
2288 @findex NO_REGS
2289 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2290 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2291 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2292 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2293
2294 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2295 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2296 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2297 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2298 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2299 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2300
2301 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2302 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2303
2304 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2305 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2306 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2307 them in operand constraints.
2308
2309 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2310 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2311 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2312 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2313 (@pxref{Costs}).
2314
2315 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2316 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2317 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2318 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2319 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2320 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2321 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2322
2323 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2324 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2325 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2326 in their union.
2327
2328 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2329 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2330 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2331 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2332 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2333
2334 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2335 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2336 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2337 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2338 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2339 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2340 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2341 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2342 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2343
2344 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2345 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2346 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2347 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2348 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2349 tells how many classes there are.
2350
2351 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2352 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2353 in many of the tables described below.
2354 @end deftp
2355
2356 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2357 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2358
2359 @smallexample
2360 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2361 @end smallexample
2362 @end defmac
2363
2364 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2365 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2366 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2367 @end defmac
2368
2369 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2370 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2371 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2372 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2373 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2374
2375 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2376 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2377 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2378 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2379 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2380 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2381 so on.
2382 @end defmac
2383
2384 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2385 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2386 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2387 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2388 register.
2389 @end defmac
2390
2391 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2392 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2393 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2394 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2395 @end defmac
2396
2397 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2398 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2399 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2400 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2401 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2402 @end defmac
2403
2404 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2405 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2406 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2407 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2408 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2409 @end defmac
2410
2411 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2412 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2413 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2414 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2415 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2416 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2417 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2418 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2419 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2420 @end defmac
2421
2422 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2423 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2424 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2425 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2426 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2427 @end defmac
2428
2429 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2430 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2431 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2432 @end defmac
2433
2434 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2435 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2436 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2437 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2438 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2439 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2440 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2441 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2442 @code{address_operand}.
2443 @end defmac
2444
2445 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2446 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2447 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2448 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2449 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2450 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2451 than other base register uses.
2452
2453 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2454 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2455 @end defmac
2456
2457 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2458 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2459 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2460 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2461 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2462 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2463 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2464 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2465 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2466 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2467 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2468 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2469 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2470 @end defmac
2471
2472 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2473 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2474 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2475 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2476 allocated such a hard register.
2477
2478 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2479 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2480 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2481 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2482 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2483 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2484 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2485 only if neither labeling works.
2486 @end defmac
2487
2488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2489 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2490 @end deftypefn
2491
2492 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2493 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2494 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2495 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2496 another, smaller class.
2497
2498 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2499
2500 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2501 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2502 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2503 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2504 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2505
2506 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2507 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2508 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2509 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2510 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2511 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2512 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2513 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2514 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2515 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2516 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2517
2518 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2519 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2520 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2521 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2522 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2523 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2524 @end deftypefn
2525
2526 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2527 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2528 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2529 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2530 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2531 safe:
2532
2533 @smallexample
2534 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2535 @end smallexample
2536
2537 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2538 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2539 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2540 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2541 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2542
2543 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2544 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2545 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2546 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2547 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2548 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2549 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2550 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2551 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2552 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2553 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2554
2555 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2556 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2557 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2558 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2559 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2560 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2561 @end defmac
2562
2563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2564 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2565 input reloads.
2566
2567 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2568 argument.
2569
2570 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2571 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2572 @end deftypefn
2573
2574 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2575 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2576 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2577 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2578 ordinarily be used.
2579
2580 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2581 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2582
2583 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2584 smaller class.
2585
2586 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2587 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2588 @end defmac
2589
2590 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2591 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2592 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2593 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2594 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2595 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2596 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2597 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2598 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2599 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2600 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2601 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2602 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2603
2604 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2605 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2606 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2607 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2608 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2609 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2610 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2611 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2612 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2613 of the scratch register(s).
2614
2615 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2616
2617 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2618 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2619 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2620 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2621 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2622
2623 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2624 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2625 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2626 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2627 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2628 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2629
2630 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2631 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2632 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2633 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2634 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2635
2636 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2637 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2638 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2639 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2640 single-register-class
2641 @c [later: or memory]
2642 output constraint.
2643
2644 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2645 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2646 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2647 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2648
2649 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2650 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2651 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2652 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2653 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2654 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2655 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2656 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2657
2658
2659 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2660 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2661 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2662 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2663
2664 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2665 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2666 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2667
2668 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2669 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2670 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2671 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2672 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2673 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2674 @end deftypefn
2675
2676 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2678 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2679 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2680 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2681
2682 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2683 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2684 reload phase that it may
2685 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2686 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2687 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2688 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2689 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2690 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2691
2692 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2693 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2694 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2695 class required. If the
2696 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2697 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2698 macros identically.
2699
2700 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2701 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2702 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2703 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2704 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2705
2706 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2707 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2708 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2709 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2710 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2711 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2712 register.
2713
2714 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2715 register that
2716 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2717 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2718 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2719 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2720 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2721
2722 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2723 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2724 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2725 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2726
2727 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2728 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2729 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2730 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2731 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2732 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2733 general registers.
2734 @end defmac
2735
2736 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2737 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2738 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2739 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2740 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2741 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2742 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2743
2744 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2745 @end defmac
2746
2747 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2748 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2749 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2750 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2751 defined by this macro.
2752
2753 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2754 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2755 @end defmac
2756
2757 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2758 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2759 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2760 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2761 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2762 same as that of @var{mode}.
2763
2764 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2765 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2766 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2767 registers.
2768
2769 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2770 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2771 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2772 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2773 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2774 details.
2775
2776 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2777 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2778 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2779 @end defmac
2780
2781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2782 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2783 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2784 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2785
2786 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2787 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2788 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2789 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2790 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2791
2792 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2793 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2794 pressure.
2795 @end deftypefn
2796
2797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2798 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2799 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2800
2801 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2802 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2803 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2804 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2805 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2806
2807 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2808 in the reload pass.
2809
2810 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2811 in words.
2812 @end deftypefn
2813
2814 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2815 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2816 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2817
2818 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2819 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2820 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2821 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2822
2823 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2824 in the reload pass.
2825 @end defmac
2826
2827 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2828 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2829 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2830
2831 For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2832 floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2833 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2834 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2835 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2836 as below:
2837
2838 @smallexample
2839 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2840 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2841 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2842 @end smallexample
2843
2844 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2845 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2846 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2847 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2848 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2849 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2850 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2851 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2852 value that the middle-end intended.
2853
2854 @end defmac
2855
2856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2857 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2858 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2859
2860 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2861 @end deftypefn
2862
2863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2864 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2865 @end deftypefn
2866
2867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2868 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2869 @end deftypefn
2870
2871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2872 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2873 @end deftypefn
2874
2875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2876 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2877 @end deftypefn
2878
2879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2880 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2881 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2882 register allocation.
2883 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2884 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2885 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2886 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2887 @end deftypefn
2888
2889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2890 A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2891 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2892 at memory mode @var{mode}.
2893 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2894 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2895 addressing.
2896 @end deftypefn
2897
2898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2899 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2900 @end deftypefn
2901
2902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2903 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2904 @end deftypefn
2905
2906 @node Stack and Calling
2907 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2908 @cindex calling conventions
2909
2910 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2911 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2912
2913 @menu
2914 * Frame Layout::
2915 * Exception Handling::
2916 * Stack Checking::
2917 * Frame Registers::
2918 * Elimination::
2919 * Stack Arguments::
2920 * Register Arguments::
2921 * Scalar Return::
2922 * Aggregate Return::
2923 * Caller Saves::
2924 * Function Entry::
2925 * Profiling::
2926 * Tail Calls::
2927 * Shrink-wrapping separate components::
2928 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2929 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2930 @end menu
2931
2932 @node Frame Layout
2933 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2934 @cindex stack frame layout
2935 @cindex frame layout
2936
2937 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2938 Here is the basic stack layout.
2939
2940 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2941 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2942 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2943 @end defmac
2944
2945 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2946 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2947 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2948 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2949
2950 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2951 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2952 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2953 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2954 space for the next item on the stack.
2955
2956 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2957 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2958 which is often wrong.
2959 @end defmac
2960
2961 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2962 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2963 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2964 @end defmac
2965
2966 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2967 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2968 addresses on the stack.
2969 @end defmac
2970
2971 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2972 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2973
2974 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2975 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2976 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2977 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2978 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2979 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2980 @end defmac
2981
2982 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2983 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2984 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2985
2986 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2987 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2988 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2989 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2990 @end defmac
2991
2992 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2993 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2994 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2995 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2996
2997 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2998 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2999 @end defmac
3000
3001 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3002 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3003 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3004 function.
3005
3006 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3007 the first argument's address.
3008 @end defmac
3009
3010 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3011 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3012 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3013
3014 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3015 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3016 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3017 @end defmac
3018
3019 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3020 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3021 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3022 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3023 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3024 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3025 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3026 @end defmac
3027
3028 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3029 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3030 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3031 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3032 itself.
3033
3034 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3035 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3036 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3037 @end defmac
3038
3039 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3040 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3041 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3042 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3043 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3044 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3045 @end defmac
3046
3047 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3048 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3049 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3050 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3051 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3052 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3053 @end deftypefn
3054
3055 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3056 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3057 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3058 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3059 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3060 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3061 @end defmac
3062
3063 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3064 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3065 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3066 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3067 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3068 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3069
3070 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3071 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3072 determine the return address of other frames.
3073 @end defmac
3074
3075 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3076 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3077 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3078 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3079 @end defmac
3080
3081 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3082 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3083 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3084 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3085 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3086 the stack.
3087
3088 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3089 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3090
3091 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3092 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3093 @end defmac
3094
3095 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3096 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3097 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3098 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3099 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3100
3101 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3102 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3103 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3104 over time.
3105 @end defmac
3106
3107 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3108 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3109 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3110 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3111 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3112 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3113 @end defmac
3114
3115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3116 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3117 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3118 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3119 @smallexample
3120 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3121 @end smallexample
3122 and
3123 @smallexample
3124 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3125 @end smallexample
3126 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3127 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3128 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3129 @end deftypefn
3130
3131 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3132 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3133 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3134 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3135 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3136 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3137
3138 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3139 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3140 @end defmac
3141
3142 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3143 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3144 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3145 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3146 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3147 during virtual register instantiation.
3148
3149 The default value for this macro is
3150 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3151 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3152 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3153 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3154 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3155
3156 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3157 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3158 DWARF 2.
3159 @end defmac
3160
3161 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3162 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3163 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3164 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3165 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3166
3167 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3168 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3169 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3170 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3171 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3172 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3173 should be defined.
3174 @end defmac
3175
3176 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3177 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3178 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3179 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3180 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3181 @end defmac
3182
3183 @node Exception Handling
3184 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3185 @cindex exception handling
3186
3187 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3188 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3189 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3190 @var{N} registers are usable.
3191
3192 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3193 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3194 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3195 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3196 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3197
3198 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3199 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3200 @end defmac
3201
3202 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3203 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3204 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3205 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3206 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3207
3208 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3209 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3210
3211 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3212 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3213 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3214 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3215 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3216 that provided by DWARF 2.
3217 @end defmac
3218
3219 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3220 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3221 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3222 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3223
3224 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3225 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3226 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3227 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3228 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3229 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3230 target call frame.
3231
3232 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3233 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3234 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3235
3236 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3237 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3238 @end defmac
3239
3240 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3241 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3242 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3243 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3244 using it to return to the exception handler.
3245 @end defmac
3246
3247 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3248 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3249 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3250 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3251 and so may be read-only.
3252
3253 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3254 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3255 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3256 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3257
3258 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3259 represented directly.
3260 @end defmac
3261
3262 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3263 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3264 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3265 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3266 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3267
3268 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3269 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3270 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3271 to be emitted.
3272 @end defmac
3273
3274 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3275 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3276 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3277 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3278 through signal frames.
3279
3280 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3281 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3282 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3283 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3284 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3285 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3286 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3287 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3288 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3289
3290 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3291 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3292 @end defmac
3293
3294 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3295 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3296 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3297 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3298
3299 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3300 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3301 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3302 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3303 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3304 be updated in @var{fs}.
3305 @end defmac
3306
3307 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3308 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3309 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3310 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3311 @end defmac
3312
3313 @node Stack Checking
3314 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3315
3316 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3317 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3318 three ways:
3319
3320 @enumerate
3321 @item
3322 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3323 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3324 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3325 other special processing.
3326
3327 @item
3328 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3329 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3330 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3331 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3332 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3333 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3334 approach below.
3335
3336 @item
3337 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3338 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3339 @end enumerate
3340
3341 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3342 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3343 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3344 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3345
3346 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3347 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3348 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3349 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3350 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3351 value of this macro is zero.
3352 @end defmac
3353
3354 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3355 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3356 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3357 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3358 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3359 @end defmac
3360
3361 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3362 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3363 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3364 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3365 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3366 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3367 @end defmac
3368
3369 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3370 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3371 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3372 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3373 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3374 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3375 default value of this macro is zero.
3376 @end defmac
3377
3378 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3379 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3380 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3381 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3382 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3383 architectures and operating systems.
3384 @end defmac
3385
3386 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3387 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3388 in the opposite case.
3389
3390 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3391 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3392 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3393 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3394 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3395 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3396 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3397 @end defmac
3398
3399 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3400 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3401 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3402 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3403 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3404 use the default of four words.
3405 @end defmac
3406
3407 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3408 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3409 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3410 @option{-fstack-check}.
3411 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3412 normally not need to override that default.
3413 @end defmac
3414
3415 @need 2000
3416 @node Frame Registers
3417 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3418
3419 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3420 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3421
3422 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3423 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3424 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3425 the hardware determines which register this is.
3426 @end defmac
3427
3428 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3429 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3430 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3431 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3432 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3433 @end defmac
3434
3435 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3436 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3437 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3438 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3439 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3440 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3441 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3442 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3443 used for the frame pointer.
3444
3445 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3446 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3447 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3448 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3449 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3450 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3451 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3452
3453 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3454 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3455 @end defmac
3456
3457 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3458 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3459 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3460 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3461 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3462 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3463 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3464 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3465 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3466 @end defmac
3467
3468 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3469 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3470 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3471 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3472 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3473 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3474 @end defmac
3475
3476 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3477 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3478 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3479 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3480 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3481 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3482 @end defmac
3483
3484 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3485 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3486 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3487 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3488 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3489 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3490 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3491
3492 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3493 address from the stack.
3494 @end defmac
3495
3496 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3497 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3498 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3499 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3500 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3501 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3502 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3503 not be defined.
3504
3505 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3506
3507 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3508 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3509 @end defmac
3510
3511 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3512 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3513 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3514 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3515 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3516 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3517
3518 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3519
3520 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3521 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3522 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3523 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3524 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3525 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3526 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3527 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3528 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3529 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3530 to refer to those items.
3531 @end deftypefn
3532
3533 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3534 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3535 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3536 DWARF2 exception handling.
3537
3538 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3539 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3540 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3541 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3542 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3543 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3544 registers that are not call-saved.
3545
3546 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3547 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3548 @end defmac
3549
3550 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3551
3552 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3553 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3554
3555 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3556 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3557 @end defmac
3558
3559 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3560
3561 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3562 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3563 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3564 column number to use instead.
3565
3566 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3567 @end defmac
3568
3569 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3570
3571 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3572 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3573 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3574 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3575 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3576
3577 @end defmac
3578
3579 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3580
3581 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3582 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3583 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3584 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3585 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3586
3587 @end defmac
3588
3589 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3590
3591 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3592 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3593 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3594 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3595
3596 @end defmac
3597
3598 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3599
3600 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3601 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3602 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3603 defined and 0 otherwise.
3604
3605 @end defmac
3606
3607 @node Elimination
3608 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3609
3610 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3611 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3612
3613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3614 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3615 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3616 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3617
3618 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3619 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3620 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3621 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3622 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3623 pointer.
3624
3625 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3626 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3627 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3628 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
3629 them.
3630
3631 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3632 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3633 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3634
3635 Default return value is @code{false}.
3636 @end deftypefn
3637
3638 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3639 This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3640 unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3641
3642 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3643 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3644
3645 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3646 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3647 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3648 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3649 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3650
3651 In this case, you might specify:
3652 @smallexample
3653 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3654 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3655 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3656 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3657 @end smallexample
3658
3659 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3660 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3661 @end defmac
3662
3663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3664 This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3665 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3666 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3667 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3668 knows about.
3669
3670 Default return value is @code{true}.
3671 @end deftypefn
3672
3673 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3674 This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3675 of registers. The value would be computed from information
3676 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3677 registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3678 @end defmac
3679
3680 @node Stack Arguments
3681 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3682 @cindex arguments on stack
3683 @cindex stack arguments
3684
3685 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3686 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3687 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3688
3689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3690 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3691 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3692 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3693 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3694 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3695 @end deftypefn
3696
3697 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3698 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3699 outgoing arguments.
3700 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3701 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3702 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3703 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3704 @end defmac
3705
3706 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3707 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3708 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3709 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3710 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3711 @end defmac
3712
3713 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3714 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3715 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3716
3717 On some machines, the definition
3718
3719 @smallexample
3720 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3721 @end smallexample
3722
3723 @noindent
3724 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3725 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3726 alignment. Then the definition should be
3727
3728 @smallexample
3729 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3730 @end smallexample
3731
3732 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3733 @end defmac
3734
3735 @findex outgoing_args_size
3736 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3737 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3738 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3739 will be computed and placed into
3740 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3741 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3742 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3743
3744 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3745 is not proper.
3746 @end defmac
3747
3748 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3749 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3750 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3751 registers.
3752
3753 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3754 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3755 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3756 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3757 of the function.
3758
3759 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3760 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3761 which.
3762 @end defmac
3763 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3764 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3765
3766 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3767 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3768 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3769 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3770 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3771 @end defmac
3772
3773 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3774 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3775 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3776 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3777 if the function called is a library function.
3778
3779 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3780 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3781 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3782 @end defmac
3783
3784 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3785 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3786 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3787 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3788 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3789
3790 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3791 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3792 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3793 stack in its natural location.
3794 @end defmac
3795
3796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3797 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3798 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3799 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3800
3801 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3802 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3803 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3804 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3805
3806 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3807 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3808 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3809 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3810 arguments (if known).
3811
3812 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3813 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3814 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3815 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3816 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3817 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3818
3819 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3820 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3821 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3822
3823 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3824 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3825 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3826 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3827 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3828 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3829 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3830 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3831 number of arguments.
3832 @end deftypefn
3833
3834 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3835 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3836 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3837 when compiling a function call.
3838
3839 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3840 have been accumulated.
3841
3842 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3843 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3844 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3845 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3846 appropriate.
3847 @end defmac
3848
3849 @node Register Arguments
3850 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3851 @cindex arguments in registers
3852 @cindex registers arguments
3853
3854 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3855 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3856 the stack.
3857
3858 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3859 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3860 register and if so, which register.
3861
3862 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3863 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3864 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3865 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3866 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3867 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3868 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3869 syntax error has previously occurred.
3870
3871 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3872 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3873 on the stack.
3874
3875 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3876 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3877 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3878 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3879 for more information.
3880
3881 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3882 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3883 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3884 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3885 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3886 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3887 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3888 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3889 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3890 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3891 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3892 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3893 argument is also stored on the stack.
3894
3895 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3896 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3897 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3898
3899 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3900 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3901 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3902 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3903 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3904 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3905
3906 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3907 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3908 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3909 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3910 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3911 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3912 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3913 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3914 a register.
3915 @end deftypefn
3916
3917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3918 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3919 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3920 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3921 documentation.
3922 @end deftypefn
3923
3924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3925 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
3926 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
3927 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
3928 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
3929
3930 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3931 which the caller passes the value, and
3932 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3933 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3934 arrive.
3935
3936 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
3937 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
3938 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
3939
3940 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3941 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3942 @end deftypefn
3943
3944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3945 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3946 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3947 @end deftypefn
3948
3949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3950 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3951 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3952 @end deftypefn
3953
3954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3955 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3956 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3957 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3958 pushed on the stack.
3959
3960 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3961 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3962 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3963 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3964 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3965 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3966 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3967
3968 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3969 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3970 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3971 @end deftypefn
3972
3973 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3974 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3975 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
3976 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3977 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3978
3979 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3980 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3981 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3982 to that type.
3983 @end deftypefn
3984
3985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3986 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3987 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
3988 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
3989 by the caller.
3990
3991 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
3992 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
3993 not be generated.
3994
3995 The default version of this hook always returns false.
3996 @end deftypefn
3997
3998 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3999 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4000 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4001 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4002 of bytes of argument so far.
4003
4004 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4005 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4006 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4007 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4008 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4009 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4010 @end defmac
4011
4012 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4013 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4014 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4015 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4016 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4017 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4018 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4019 @end defmac
4020
4021 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4022 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4023 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4024 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4025 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4026 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4027 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4028 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4029 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4030 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4031 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4032 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4033 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4034
4035 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4036 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4037 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4038 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4039 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4040 never both of them at once.
4041 @end defmac
4042
4043 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4044 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4045 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4046 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4047 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4048 0)} is used instead.
4049 @end defmac
4050
4051 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4052 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4053 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4054 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4055
4056 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4057 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4058 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4059 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4060 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4061 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4062 @end defmac
4063
4064 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4065 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4066 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4067 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4068 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4069 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4070
4071 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4072 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4073 used for arguments without any special help.
4074 @end deftypefn
4075
4076 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4077 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4078 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4079 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4080 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4081 top.
4082 @end defmac
4083
4084 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4085 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4086 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4087 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4088 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4089
4090 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4091 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4092 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4093
4094 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4095 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4096 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4097 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4098 @end defmac
4099
4100 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4101 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4102 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4103 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4104 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4105 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4106 @end defmac
4107
4108 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4109 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4110 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4111 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4112 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4113 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4114 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4115 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4116 required.
4117 @end defmac
4118
4119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4120 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4121 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4122 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4123 @end deftypefn
4124
4125 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4126 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4127 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4128 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4129 value.
4130 @end deftypefn
4131
4132 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4133 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4134 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4135 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4136 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4137 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4138 stack.
4139 @end defmac
4140
4141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4142 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4143 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4144 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4145 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4146 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4147 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4148 point register.
4149
4150 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4151 false.
4152 @end deftypefn
4153
4154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4155 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4156 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4157 @end deftypefn
4158
4159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4160 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4161 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4162 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4163 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4164 variable.
4165 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4166 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4167 internal type.
4168 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4169 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4170 macro to iterate through all types.
4171 @end deftypefn
4172
4173 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4174 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4175 @var{fndecl}.
4176 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4177 @end deftypefn
4178
4179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4180 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4181 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4182 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4183 @end deftypefn
4184
4185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4186 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4187 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4188 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4189 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4190 @end deftypefn
4191
4192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4193 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4194 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4195 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4196 @end deftypefn
4197
4198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4199 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4200 @end deftypefn
4201
4202 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4203 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4204 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4205 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4206 must work.
4207
4208 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4209 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4210 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4211 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4212 @end deftypefn
4213
4214 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4215 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4216 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4217 must have move patterns for this mode.
4218 @end deftypefn
4219
4220 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4221 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4222 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4223 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4224 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4225
4226 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4227 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4228 has operations like:
4229
4230 @smallexample
4231 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4232 @end smallexample
4233
4234 where the return type is defined as:
4235
4236 @smallexample
4237 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4238 @{
4239 int8x8_t val[3];
4240 @} int8x8x3_t;
4241 @end smallexample
4242
4243 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4244 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4245 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4246 @end deftypefn
4247
4248 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4249 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4250 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4251 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4252 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4253 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4254 @end deftypefn
4255
4256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4257 Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4258 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4259 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type
4260 is not supported, return @code{VOIDmode}. The default version of this
4261 hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4262 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4263 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4264 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4265 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4266 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4267 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4268 @code{VOIDmode}. The hook is only called for values of @var{n} and
4269 @var{extended} that are valid according to ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that
4270 is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or, if @var{extended} is false, 16 or
4271 greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4272 @end deftypefn
4273
4274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4275 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4276 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4277 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4278 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4279 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4280 for any mode.
4281
4282 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4283 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4284 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4285 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4286 insn.
4287
4288 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4289 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4290 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4291 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4292 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4293 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4294 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4295 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4296 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4297
4298 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4299 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4300 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4301 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4302 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4303 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4304 @end deftypefn
4305
4306 @node Scalar Return
4307 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4308 @cindex return values in registers
4309 @cindex values, returned by functions
4310 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4311
4312 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4313 values---values that can fit in registers.
4314
4315 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4316
4317 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4318 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4319 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4320 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4321 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4322 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4323 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4324 a function returns a value.
4325
4326 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4327 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4328 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4329 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4330 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4331 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4332 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4333 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4334 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4335 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4336 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4337 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4338
4339 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4340 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4341 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4342
4343 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4344 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4345 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4346 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4347 known.
4348
4349 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4350 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4351 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4352 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4353
4354 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4355 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4356 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4357 @end deftypefn
4358
4359 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4360 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4361 a new target instead.
4362 @end defmac
4363
4364 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4365 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4366 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4367
4368 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4369 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4370 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4371 compiled.
4372 @end defmac
4373
4374 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4375 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4376 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4377
4378 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4379 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4380 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4381
4382 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4383 @end deftypefn
4384
4385 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4386 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4387 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4388
4389 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4390 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4391 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4392 suffices:
4393
4394 @smallexample
4395 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4396 @end smallexample
4397
4398 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4399 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4400 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4401
4402 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4403 for a new target instead.
4404 @end defmac
4405
4406 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4407 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4408 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4409
4410 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4411 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4412 recognized by this target hook.
4413
4414 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4415 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4416 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4417
4418 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4419 @end deftypefn
4420
4421 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4422 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4423 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4424 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4425 @end defmac
4426
4427 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4428 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4429 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4430 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4431 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4432 undesirable on your target.
4433 @end deftypevr
4434
4435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4436 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4437 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4438 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4439 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4440
4441 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4442 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4443 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4444 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4445 @code{SImode} rtx.
4446 @end deftypefn
4447
4448 @node Aggregate Return
4449 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4450 @cindex aggregates as return values
4451 @cindex large return values
4452 @cindex returning aggregate values
4453 @cindex structure value address
4454
4455 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4456 cases), the value is not returned according to
4457 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4458 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4459 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4460 address}.
4461
4462 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4463 memory.
4464
4465 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4466 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4467 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4468 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4469 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4470 libcalls.
4471
4472 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4473 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4474 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4475 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4476 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4477 values, and 0 otherwise.
4478
4479 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4480 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4481 to indicate this.
4482 @end deftypefn
4483
4484 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4485 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4486 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4487 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4488 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4489 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4490 target hook.
4491
4492 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4493 @end defmac
4494
4495 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4496 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4497 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4498 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4499 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4500 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4501 argument.
4502
4503 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4504 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4505 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4506 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4507 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4508 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4509 the caller.
4510
4511 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4512 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4513 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4514 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4515 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4516 @end deftypefn
4517
4518 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4519 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4520 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4521 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4522
4523 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4524 pass an address to the subroutine.
4525
4526 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4527 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4528 @end defmac
4529
4530 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4531 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4532 @end deftypefn
4533
4534 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4535 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4536 @end deftypefn
4537
4538 @node Caller Saves
4539 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4540
4541 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4542 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4543 must live across calls.
4544
4545 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4546 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4547 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4548 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4549 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4550 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4551 @end defmac
4552
4553 @node Function Entry
4554 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4555 @cindex function entry and exit
4556 @cindex prologue
4557 @cindex epilogue
4558
4559 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4560 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4561
4562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4563 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4564 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4565 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4566 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4567 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4568 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4569
4570 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4571 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4572
4573 @findex regs_ever_live
4574 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4575 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4576 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4577 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4578 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4579 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4580
4581 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4582 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4583 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4584 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4585 registers are used in the function.
4586
4587 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4588 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4589 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4590 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4591 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4592 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4593 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4594
4595 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4596 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4597 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4598 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4599 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4600 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4601 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4602 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4603 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4604 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4605 @end deftypefn
4606
4607 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4608 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4609 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4610 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4611 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4612 @end deftypefn
4613
4614 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4615 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4616 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4617 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4618 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4619 @end deftypefn
4620
4621 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4622 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4623 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4624 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4625 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4626 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4627 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4628 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4629
4630 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4631 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4632 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4633 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4634
4635 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4636 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4637 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4638 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4639 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4640 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4641
4642 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4643 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4644 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4645 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4646 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4647 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4648
4649 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4650 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4651 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4652 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4653
4654 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4655 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4656 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4657 number of arguments.
4658
4659 @findex pops_args
4660 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4661 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4662 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4663 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4664 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4665 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4666 @end deftypefn
4667
4668 @itemize @bullet
4669 @item
4670 @findex pretend_args_size
4671 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4672 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4673 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4674 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4675 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4676 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4677 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4678 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4679 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4680 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4681
4682 @item
4683 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4684 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4685 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4686 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4687 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4688 a save area.
4689
4690 @item
4691 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4692 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4693 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4694 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4695
4696 @item
4697 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4698 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4699 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4700 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4701 @end itemize
4702
4703 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4704 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4705 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4706 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4707 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4708 default is 0.
4709
4710 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4711 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4712 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4713 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4714 @end defmac
4715
4716 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4717 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4718 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4719 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4720 @end defmac
4721
4722 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4723 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4724 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4725 on entry to an exception edge.
4726 @end defmac
4727
4728 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4729 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4730 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4731 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4732 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4733 the real function.
4734
4735 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4736 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4737 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4738 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4739 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4740 all other incoming arguments.
4741
4742 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4743 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4744 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4745
4746 @smallexample
4747 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4751 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4752 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4753 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4754
4755 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4756 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4757 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4758 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4759
4760 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4761 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4762 some targets, but probably not.
4763
4764 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4765 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4766 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4767 not support varargs.
4768 @end deftypefn
4769
4770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4771 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4772 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4773 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4774 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4775 previously exposed.
4776 @end deftypefn
4777
4778 @node Profiling
4779 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4780 @cindex profiling, code generation
4781
4782 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4783
4784 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4785 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4786 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4787
4788 @findex mcount
4789 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4790 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4791 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4792 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4793
4794 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4795 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4796 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4797 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4798 @end defmac
4799
4800 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4801 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4802 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4803 not support profiling.
4804 @end defmac
4805
4806 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4807 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4808 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4809 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4810 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4811 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4812 @end defmac
4813
4814 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4815 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4816 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4817 @end defmac
4818
4819 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4820 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4821 @end deftypefn
4822
4823 @node Tail Calls
4824 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4825 @cindex tail calls
4826
4827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4828 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4829 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4830 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4831
4832 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4833 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4834 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4835 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4836 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4837 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4838 @end deftypefn
4839
4840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4841 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4842 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4843 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4844 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4845 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4846 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4847 @end deftypefn
4848
4849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4850 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4851 @end deftypefn
4852
4853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4854 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4855 @end deftypefn
4856
4857 @node Shrink-wrapping separate components
4858 @subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
4859 @cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
4860
4861 The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
4862 saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
4863 stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
4864 up the static chain, etc.
4865
4866 On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
4867 thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
4868 referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
4869 independent parts of GCC.
4870
4871 Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
4872 shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
4873 teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
4874 paths where this would unnecessary.
4875
4876 What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
4877 code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
4878 @code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
4879 and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
4880 generic code.
4881
4882 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
4883 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4884 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
4885 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
4886 shrink-wrapping.
4887 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
4888 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
4889 @end deftypefn
4890
4891 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
4892 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4893 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
4894 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
4895 @end deftypefn
4896
4897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
4898 This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
4899 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
4900 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
4901 epilogue instead.
4902 @end deftypefn
4903
4904 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4905 Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4906 @end deftypefn
4907
4908 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4909 Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4910 @end deftypefn
4911
4912 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4913 Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
4914 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
4915 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
4916 will be deleted after this call.
4917 @end deftypefn
4918
4919 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4920 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4921 @cindex stack smashing protection
4922
4923 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4924 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4925 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4926 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4927 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4928 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4929
4930 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4931 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4932 @end deftypefn
4933
4934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4935 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4936 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4937 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4938
4939 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4940 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4941 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4942 @end deftypefn
4943
4944 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4945 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4946 @end deftypefn
4947
4948 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4949 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4950 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4951
4952 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
4953 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4954 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4955 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4956 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4957 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4958 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4959 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4960 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
4961 @end deftypevr
4962
4963 @node Varargs
4964 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4965 @cindex varargs implementation
4966
4967 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4968 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4969 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4970 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4971 conditionals to include it.
4972
4973 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4974 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4975 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4976 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4977 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4978 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4979
4980 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4981 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4982 below.
4983
4984 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4985 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4986 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4987 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4988 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4989
4990 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4991 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4992 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4993 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4994
4995 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4996 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4997 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4998 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4999 to use them for its own purposes.
5000 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5001 @c 10feb93
5002 @end defmac
5003
5004 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5005 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5006 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5007 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5008 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5009 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5010 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5011 of the current function.
5012 @end defmac
5013
5014 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5015 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5016 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5017 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5018 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5019 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5020
5021 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5022 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5023 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5024
5025 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5026 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5027 @end defmac
5028
5029 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5030
5031 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5032 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5033 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5034 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5035 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5036 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5037 @end deftypefn
5038
5039 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5040 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5041 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5042 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5043 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5044 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5045 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5046 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5047
5048 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5049 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5050 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5051 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5052
5053 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5054 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5055 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5056 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5057 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5058 frame.
5059
5060 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5061 compile time without knowing their data types,
5062 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5063 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5064 for all data types.
5065
5066 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5067 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5068 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5069 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5070 not generate any instructions in this case.
5071 @end deftypefn
5072
5073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5074 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5075 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5076
5077 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5078 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5079 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5080 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5081 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5082 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5083 except the last are treated as named.
5084
5085 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5086 @end deftypefn
5087
5088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5089 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5090 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5091 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5092 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5093 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5094 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5095 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5096 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5097 registers if a target needs it.
5098 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5099 passed instead of an argument register.
5100 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5101 @end deftypefn
5102
5103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5104 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5105 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5106 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5107 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5108 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5109 @end deftypefn
5110
5111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5112 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5113 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5114 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5115 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5116 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5117 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5118 @end deftypefn
5119
5120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5121 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5122 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5123 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5124 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5125 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5126 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5127 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5128 @end deftypefn
5129
5130 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5131 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5132 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5133 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5134 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5135 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5136 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5137 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5138 @end deftypefn
5139
5140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5141 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5142 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5143 loaded bounds.
5144 @end deftypefn
5145
5146 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5147 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5148 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5149 @end deftypefn
5150
5151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5152 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5153 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5154 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5155 @end deftypefn
5156
5157 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5158 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5159 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5160 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5161 @end deftypefn
5162
5163 @node Trampolines
5164 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5165 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5166 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5167
5168 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5169 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5170 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5171 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5172 trampoline.
5173
5174 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5175 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5176 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5177 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5178 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5179 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5180 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5181 operands.
5182
5183 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5184 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5185 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5186 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5187 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5188 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5189 separately.
5190
5191 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5192 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5193 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5194 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5195 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5196
5197 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5198 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5199 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5200 to generate it on the spot.
5201 @end deftypefn
5202
5203 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5204 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5205 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5206 @end defmac
5207
5208 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5209 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5210 @end defmac
5211
5212 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5213 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5214
5215 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5216 is used for aligning trampolines.
5217 @end defmac
5218
5219 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5220 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5221 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5222 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5223 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5224 when it is called.
5225
5226 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5227 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5228 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5229 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5230 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5231 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5232
5233 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5234 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5235 initializing the trampoline proper.
5236 @end deftypefn
5237
5238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5239 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5240 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5241 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5242 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5243 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5244 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5245 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5246 @end deftypefn
5247
5248 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5249 This hook should be defined to a power of 2 if the target will benefit
5250 from the use of custom descriptors for nested functions instead of the
5251 standard trampolines. Such descriptors are created at run time on the
5252 stack and made up of data only, but they are non-standard so the generated
5253 code must be prepared to deal with them. This hook should be defined to 0
5254 if the target uses function descriptors for its standard calling sequence,
5255 like for example HP-PA or IA-64. Using descriptors for nested functions
5256 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5257 it to be made executable.
5258
5259 The value of the macro is used to parameterize the run-time identification
5260 scheme implemented to distinguish descriptors from function addresses: it
5261 gives the number of bytes by which their address is misaligned compared
5262 with function addresses. The value of 1 will generally work, unless it is
5263 already reserved by the target for another purpose, like for example on ARM.
5264 @end deftypevr
5265
5266 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5267 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5268 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5269 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5270
5271 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5272 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5273 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5274 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5275 latter makes initialization faster.
5276
5277 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5278 the following macro.
5279
5280 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5281 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5282 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5283 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5284 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5285 @end defmac
5286
5287 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5288 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5289 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5290 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5291 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5292
5293 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5294 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5295 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5296 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5297 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5298
5299 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5300 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5301 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5302 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5303 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5304 special assembler code.
5305 @end defmac
5306
5307 @node Library Calls
5308 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5309 @cindex library subroutine names
5310 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5311
5312 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5313 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5314
5315 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5316 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5317 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5318 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5319 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5320 @end defmac
5321
5322 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5323 @findex init_one_libfunc
5324 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5325 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5326 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5327 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5328 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5329 library routines.
5330
5331 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5332 @end deftypefn
5333
5334 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5335 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5336 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5337 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5338 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5339 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5340 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5341 @end deftypevr
5342
5343 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5344 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5345 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5346 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5347 return a tristate.
5348
5349 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5350 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5351 don't need to define this macro.
5352 @end defmac
5353
5354 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5355 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5356 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5357 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5358 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5359 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5360 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5361 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5362 @end defmac
5363
5364 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5365 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5366 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5367 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5368 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5369 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5370 @end defmac
5371
5372 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5373 @findex matherr
5374 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5375 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5376 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5377 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5378 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5379 system.
5380
5381 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5382 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5383 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5384 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5385 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5386 @end defmac
5387
5388 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5389 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5390 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5391 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5392 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5393 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5394 @end defmac
5395
5396 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5397 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5398 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5399 @end deftypefn
5400
5401 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5402 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5403 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5404 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5405 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5406 the NeXT runtime installed.
5407
5408 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5409 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5410 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5411
5412 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5413 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5414 @end defmac
5415
5416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char*} TARGET_PRINTF_POINTER_FORMAT (tree, const char **@var{flags})
5417 Determine the target @code{printf} implementation format string that the most closely corresponds to the @code{%p} format directive. The object pointed to by the @var{flags} is set to a string consisting of recognized format flags such as the @code{'#'} character.
5418 @end deftypefn
5419
5420 @node Addressing Modes
5421 @section Addressing Modes
5422 @cindex addressing modes
5423
5424 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5425 This is about addressing modes.
5426
5427 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5428 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5429 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5430 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5431 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5432 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5433 @end defmac
5434
5435 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5436 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5437 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5438 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5439 the size of the memory operand.
5440 @end defmac
5441
5442 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5443 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5444 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5445 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5446 @end defmac
5447
5448 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5449 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5450 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5451 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5452 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5453 constant addresses are supported.
5454 @end defmac
5455
5456 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5457 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5458 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5459 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5460 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5461 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5462 @end defmac
5463
5464 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5465 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5466 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5467 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5468 accept.
5469 @end defmac
5470
5471 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5472 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5473 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5474
5475 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5476 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5477 desired by the caller.
5478
5479 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5480 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5481 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5482 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5483 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5484 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5485 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5486 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5487
5488 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5489 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5490 register is required.
5491
5492 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5493 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5494 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5495 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5496 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5497
5498 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5499 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5500 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5501 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5502 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5503
5504 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5505 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5506 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5507 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5508 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5509 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5510 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5511 Format}.
5512
5513 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5514 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5515 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5516 has this syntax:
5517
5518 @example
5519 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5520 @end example
5521
5522 @noindent
5523 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5524 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5525
5526 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5527 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5528 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5529 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5530 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5531
5532 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5533 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5534 @end deftypefn
5535
5536 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5537 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5538 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5539 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5540 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5541 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5542 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5543 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5544 @code{'m'} constraint.
5545 @end defmac
5546
5547 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5548 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5549 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5550 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5551 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5552
5553 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5554 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5555
5556 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5557 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5558 @end defmac
5559
5560 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5561 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5562 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5563 address.
5564
5565 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5566 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5567 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5568 @var{x}.
5569
5570 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5571 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5572 should return the new @var{x}.
5573
5574 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5575 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5576 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5577 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5578 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5579 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5580 strategy can generate better code.
5581 @end deftypefn
5582
5583 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5584 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5585 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5586 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5587 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5588 performance reasons.
5589
5590 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5591 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5592 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5593 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5594 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5595 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5596 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5597 be shared.
5598
5599 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5600 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5601 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5602 of reload internals.
5603
5604 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5605 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5606 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5607
5608 @findex push_reload
5609 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5610 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5611 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5612
5613 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5614 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5615 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5616 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5617 @code{push_reload}.
5618
5619 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5620 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5621 the address has become legitimate.
5622
5623 @findex copy_rtx
5624 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5625 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5626 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5627 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5628 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5629 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5630 @end defmac
5631
5632 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5633 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5634 space @var{addrspace} can have
5635 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5636 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5637 but not others.
5638
5639 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5640 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5641 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5642 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5643
5644 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5645
5646 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5647 @end deftypefn
5648
5649 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5650 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5651 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5652 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5653
5654 The default definition returns true.
5655 @end deftypefn
5656
5657 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5658 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5659 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5660 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5661 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5662 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5663 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5664 into their original form.
5665 @end deftypefn
5666
5667 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5668 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5669 debug sections.
5670 @end deftypefn
5671
5672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5673 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5674 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5675 of @var{x}.
5676
5677 The default version of this hook returns false.
5678
5679 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5680 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5681 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5682 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5683 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5684 @end deftypefn
5685
5686 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5687 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5688 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5689 of @var{x}.
5690
5691 The default version returns false for all constants.
5692 @end deftypefn
5693
5694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5695 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5696 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5697
5698 The default version returns true for all decls.
5699 @end deftypefn
5700
5701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5702 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5703 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5704 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5705 @end deftypefn
5706
5707 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5708 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5709 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5710 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5711 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5712
5713 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5714 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5715 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5716 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5717 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5718 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5719 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5720 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5721 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5722 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5723 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5724
5725 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5726 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5727 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5728 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5729 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5730 described above.
5731 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5732 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5733 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5734 @end deftypefn
5735
5736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5737 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5738 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5739 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5740 @end deftypefn
5741
5742 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5743 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5744 @end deftypefn
5745
5746 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5747 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5748 @end deftypefn
5749
5750 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5751 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5752 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5753 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5754 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5755 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5756
5757 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5758 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5759 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5760 @end deftypefn
5761
5762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5763 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5764 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5765 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5766 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5767 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5768 @end deftypefn
5769
5770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5771 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5772 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5773 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5774 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5775 @end deftypefn
5776
5777 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5778 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5779 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5780 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5781 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5782 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5783 @end deftypefn
5784
5785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
5786 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5787 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5788 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5789 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5790 @end deftypefn
5791
5792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5793 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5794 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5795 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5796 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5797 @end deftypefn
5798
5799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5800 This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5801 of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5802 vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5803 @end deftypefn
5804
5805 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5806 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5807 @end deftypefn
5808
5809 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5810 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5811 @end deftypefn
5812
5813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5814 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5815 @end deftypefn
5816
5817 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5818 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5819 @end deftypefn
5820
5821 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5822 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5823 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5824 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5825 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5826 loads.
5827 @end deftypefn
5828
5829 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5830 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5831 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5832 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5833 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5834 stores.
5835 @end deftypefn
5836
5837 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5838 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5839 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5840 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5841 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5842 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5843 @end deftypefn
5844
5845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5846 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5847 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5848 @end deftypefn
5849
5850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5851 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5852 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5853 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5854 to use it.
5855 @end deftypefn
5856
5857 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
5858 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5859 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
5860 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
5861 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
5862 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
5863 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
5864 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
5865 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
5866 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5867 provide dimensions larger than 1.
5868 @end deftypefn
5869
5870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5871 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5872 or zero if unbounded.
5873 @end deftypefn
5874
5875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
5876 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5877 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5878 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5879 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5880 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5881 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5882 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
5883 @end deftypefn
5884
5885 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5886 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5887 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5888 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5889 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5890 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5891 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5892 @end deftypefn
5893
5894 @node Anchored Addresses
5895 @section Anchored Addresses
5896 @cindex anchored addresses
5897 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5898
5899 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5900 For example, if we have:
5901
5902 @smallexample
5903 static int a, b, c;
5904 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5905 @end smallexample
5906
5907 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5908 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5909 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5910 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5911 be something like:
5912
5913 @smallexample
5914 int foo (void)
5915 @{
5916 register int *xr = &x;
5917 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5918 @}
5919 @end smallexample
5920
5921 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5922 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5923
5924 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5925 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5926 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5927 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5928
5929 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5930 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5931 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5932 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5933 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5934 @end deftypevr
5935
5936 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5937 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5938 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5939 value is 0.
5940 @end deftypevr
5941
5942 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5943 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5944 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5945 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5946 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5947
5948 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5949 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5950 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5951 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5952 @end deftypefn
5953
5954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5955 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5956 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5957 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5958
5959 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5960 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5961 or target-specific sections.
5962 @end deftypefn
5963
5964 @node Condition Code
5965 @section Condition Code Status
5966 @cindex condition code status
5967
5968 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5969 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5970
5971 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5972 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5973 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5974 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5975 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5976 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5977 most RISC machines.
5978
5979 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5980 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5981 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5982 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5983 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5984 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5985
5986 These restrictions can prevent important
5987 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5988 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5989 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5990 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5991 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5992
5993 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5994 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5995 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5996 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5997 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5998 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5999 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6000
6001 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6002 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6003 interested in most macros in this section.
6004
6005 @menu
6006 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6007 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
6008 @end menu
6009
6010 @node CC0 Condition Codes
6011 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6012 @findex cc0
6013
6014 @findex cc_status
6015 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6016 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6017 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6018 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6019 currently based, and several standard flags.
6020
6021 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6022 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6023 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6024
6025 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6026 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6027 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6028
6029 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6030 @end defmac
6031
6032 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6033 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6034 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6035 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6036 define this macro to initialize it.
6037
6038 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6039 @end defmac
6040
6041 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6042 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6043 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6044 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6045 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6046 set @code{(cc0)}.
6047
6048 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6049
6050 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6051 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6052 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6053 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6054 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6055 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6056 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6057 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6058 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6059 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6060 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6061 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6062 condition code value.
6063
6064 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6065 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6066 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6067 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6068 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6069 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6070 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6071
6072 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6073 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6074 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6075 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6076 @end defmac
6077
6078 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6079 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6080 @findex CCmode
6081 @findex MODE_CC
6082
6083 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6084 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6085 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6086 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6087 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6088 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6089 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6090 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6091 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6092 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6093 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6094
6095 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6096 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6097 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6098 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6099 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6100 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6101 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6102
6103 @smallexample
6104 (define_insn ""
6105 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6106 (compare:CCNZ
6107 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6108 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6109 (const_int 0)))]
6110 ""
6111 "@dots{}")
6112 @end smallexample
6113
6114 @noindent
6115 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6116 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6117
6118 @smallexample
6119 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6120 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6121 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6122 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6123 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6124 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6125 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6126 @end smallexample
6127
6128 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6129 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6130 this section.
6131
6132 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6133 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6134 @end defmac
6135
6136 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6137 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6138 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6139 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6140 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6141
6142 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6143 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6144 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6145 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6146 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6147 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6148 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6149
6150 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6151 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6152 @file{md} file.
6153
6154 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6155 comparison code or operands.
6156 @end deftypefn
6157
6158 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6159 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6160 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6161 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6162 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6163
6164 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6165 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6166 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6167 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6168
6169 @smallexample
6170 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6171 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6172 @end smallexample
6173 @end defmac
6174
6175 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6176 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6177 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6178 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6179 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6180 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6181 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6182 like:
6183
6184 @smallexample
6185 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6186 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6187 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6188 @end smallexample
6189 @end defmac
6190
6191 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6192 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6193 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6194 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6195 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6196 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6197 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6198 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6199 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6200 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6201 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6202
6203 The default version of this hook returns false.
6204 @end deftypefn
6205
6206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6207 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6208 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6209 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6210 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6211 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6212 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6213
6214 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6215 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6216 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6217 @end deftypefn
6218
6219 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6220 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6221 @end deftypevr
6222
6223 @node Costs
6224 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6225 @cindex costs of instructions
6226 @cindex relative costs
6227 @cindex speed of instructions
6228
6229 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6230 on the target machine.
6231
6232 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6233 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6234 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6235 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6236 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6237 that.
6238
6239 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6240 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6241 registers if they are not general registers.
6242
6243 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6244 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6245 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6246 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6247 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6248 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6249
6250 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6251 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6252 @end defmac
6253
6254 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6255 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6256 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6257 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6258 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6259 that.
6260
6261 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6262 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6263 registers if they are not general registers.
6264
6265 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6266 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6267 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6268 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6269 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6270 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6271
6272 The default version of this function returns 2.
6273 @end deftypefn
6274
6275 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6276 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6277 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6278 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6279 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6280 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6281 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6282
6283 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6284 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6285 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6286 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6287 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6288 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6289
6290 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6291 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6292 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6293 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6294 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6295 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6296 are the same as to this macro.
6297
6298 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6299 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6300 @end defmac
6301
6302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6303 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6304 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6305 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6306 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6307 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6308 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6309
6310 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6311 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6312 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6313 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6314 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6315 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6316
6317 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6318 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6319 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6320 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6321 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6322 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6323 are the same as to this target hook.
6324 @end deftypefn
6325
6326 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6327 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6328 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6329 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6330 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6331 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6332 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6333 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6334 @end defmac
6335
6336 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6337 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6338 ordinarily expect.
6339
6340 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6341 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6342 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6343 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6344 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6345 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6346
6347 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6348 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6349 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6350 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6351 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6352 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6353 @end defmac
6354
6355 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6356 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6357 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6358 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6359 handler.
6360
6361 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6362 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6363 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6364 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6365 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6366
6367 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6368 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6369 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6370 @end defmac
6371
6372 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6373 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6374 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6375 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6376 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6377
6378 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6379 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6380 the number of such sequences.
6381
6382 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6383 optimized for speed rather than size.
6384
6385 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6386 @end defmac
6387
6388 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6389 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6390 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6391 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6392 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6393 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6394 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6395 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6396
6397 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6398 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6399 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6400 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6401 units.
6402
6403 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6404 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6405 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6406 under consideration.
6407
6408 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6409 optimized for speed rather than size.
6410
6411 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6412 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6413 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6414 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6415 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6416 the body of the memory operation.
6417
6418 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6419 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6420 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6421 @end deftypefn
6422
6423 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6424 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6425 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6426 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6427 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6428 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6429 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6430 negative number from this hook.
6431 @end deftypefn
6432
6433 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6434 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6435 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6436 @end defmac
6437
6438 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6439 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6440 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6441 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6442 @end defmac
6443
6444 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6445 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6446 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6447 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6448 @end defmac
6449
6450 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6451 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6452 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6453 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6454 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6455
6456 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6457 optimized for speed rather than size.
6458
6459 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6460 @end defmac
6461
6462 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6463 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6464 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6465 a block set insn or a library call.
6466 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6467 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6468
6469 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6470 optimized for speed rather than size.
6471
6472 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6473 @end defmac
6474
6475 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6476 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6477 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6478 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6479 @end defmac
6480
6481 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6482 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6483 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6484 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6485 @end defmac
6486
6487 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6488 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6489 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6490 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6491 @end defmac
6492
6493 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6494 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6495 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6496 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6497 @end defmac
6498
6499 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6500 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6501 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6502 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6503 @end defmac
6504
6505 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6506 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6507 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6508 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6509 @end defmac
6510
6511 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6512 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6513 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6514 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6515 @end defmac
6516
6517 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6518 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6519 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6520 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6521 @end defmac
6522
6523 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6524 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6525 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6526 @end defmac
6527
6528 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6529 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6530 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6531 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6532 @end defmac
6533
6534 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6535 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6536 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6537 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6538 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6539 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6540
6541 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6542 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6543 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6544
6545 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6546 @end deftypefn
6547
6548 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6549 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6550
6551 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6552 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6553 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6554 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6555 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6556 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6557 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6558
6559 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6560 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6561
6562 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6563 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6564 instructions.
6565
6566 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6567 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6568 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6569 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6570 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6571
6572 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6573 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6574 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6575
6576 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6577 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6578 @end deftypefn
6579
6580 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6581 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6582 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6583 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6584
6585 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6586 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6587 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6588 all addresses will have equal costs.
6589
6590 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6591 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6592 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6593
6594 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6595 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6596 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6597 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6598 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6599 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6600 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6601 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6602
6603 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6604
6605 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6606 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6607 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6608 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6609 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6610 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6611 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6612 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6613 @end deftypefn
6614
6615 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6616 This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6617 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6618 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6619 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6620 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6621 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6622 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6623 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6624 is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6625
6626 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6627 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6628 were true.
6629
6630 The default implementation of this hook uses the
6631 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6632 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6633 @end deftypefn
6634
6635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6636 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6637 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6638 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6639 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6640 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6641 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6642 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6643 @end deftypefn
6644
6645 @node Scheduling
6646 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6647
6648 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6649 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6650 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6651 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6652
6653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6654 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6655 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6656 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6657 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6658 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6659 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6660 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6661 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6662 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6663 @end deftypefn
6664
6665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6666 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6667 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6668 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6669 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6670 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6671 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6672 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6673 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6674 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6675 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6676 was scheduled.
6677 @end deftypefn
6678
6679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
6680 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6681 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
6682 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
6683 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
6684 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
6685 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
6686 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6687 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6688 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6689 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6690 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6691 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6692 @end deftypefn
6693
6694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6695 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6696 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6697 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6698 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6699 scheduling priorities of insns.
6700 @end deftypefn
6701
6702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6703 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6704 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6705 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6706 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6707 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6708 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6709 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6710 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6711 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6712 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6713 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6714 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6715 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6716 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6717 @end deftypefn
6718
6719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6720 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6721 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6722 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6723 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6724 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6725 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6726 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6727 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6728 @end deftypefn
6729
6730 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6731 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6732 @end deftypefn
6733
6734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6735 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6736 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6737 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6738 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6739 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6740 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6741 @end deftypefn
6742
6743 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6744 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6745 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6746 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6747 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6748 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6749 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6750 calculated.
6751 @end deftypefn
6752
6753 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6754 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6755 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6756 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6757 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6758 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6759 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6760 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6761 @end deftypefn
6762
6763 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6764 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6765 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6766 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6767 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6768 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6769 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6770 @end deftypefn
6771
6772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6773 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6774 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6775 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6776 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6777 @end deftypefn
6778
6779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6780 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6781 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6782 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6783 @end deftypefn
6784
6785 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6786 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6787 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6788 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6789 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6790 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6791 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6792 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6793 @end deftypefn
6794
6795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6796 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6797 @end deftypefn
6798
6799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6800 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6801 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6802 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6803 @end deftypefn
6804
6805 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6806 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6807 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6808 @end deftypefn
6809
6810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6811 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6812 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6813 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6814 state on a single insn is not enough.
6815 @end deftypefn
6816
6817 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6818 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6819 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6820 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6821 state on a single insn is not enough.
6822 @end deftypefn
6823
6824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6825 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6826 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6827 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6828 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6829 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6830 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6831 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6832 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6833 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6834 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6835
6836 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6837 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6838 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6839 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6840 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6841 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6842 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6843 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6844 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6845
6846 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6847 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6848 schedules to choose the best one.
6849
6850 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6851 @end deftypefn
6852
6853 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
6854
6855 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6856 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6857 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6858 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6859 the current round of multipass scheduling.
6860 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6861 number of cycles.
6862 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6863 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6864 to allow backends make correct judgements.
6865
6866 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6867 @end deftypefn
6868
6869 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6870 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6871 scheduling.
6872 @end deftypefn
6873
6874 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6875 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6876 @end deftypefn
6877
6878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6879 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6880 an instruction.
6881 @end deftypefn
6882
6883 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6884 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6885 round of multipass scheduling.
6886 @end deftypefn
6887
6888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6889 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6890 @end deftypefn
6891
6892 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6893 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6894 @end deftypefn
6895
6896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6897 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6898 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6899 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6900 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6901 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6902 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6903 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6904 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6905 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6906 and the current processor cycle.
6907 @end deftypefn
6908
6909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6910 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6911 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6912 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6913 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6914 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6915 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6916 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6917 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6918 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6919 and @code{false} otherwise.
6920
6921 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6922 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6923 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6924 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6925 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6926 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6927 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6928 @end deftypefn
6929
6930 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6931 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6932 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6933 per instruction data structures.
6934 @end deftypefn
6935
6936 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6937 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6938 @end deftypefn
6939
6940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6941 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6942 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6943 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6944 @end deftypefn
6945
6946 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6947 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6948 @end deftypefn
6949
6950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6951 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6952 @end deftypefn
6953
6954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6955 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6956 @end deftypefn
6957
6958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6959 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6960 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6961 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6962 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6963 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6964 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6965 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6966 the generated speculative pattern.
6967 @end deftypefn
6968
6969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6970 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6971 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6972 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6973 @end deftypefn
6974
6975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6976 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6977 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6978 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6979 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6980 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6981 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6982 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6983 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6984 @end deftypefn
6985
6986 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6987 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6988 enabled/used.
6989 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6990 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6991 @end deftypefn
6992
6993 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6994 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6995 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6996 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6997 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6998 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6999 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7000 @end deftypefn
7001
7002 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7003 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7004 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7005 @end deftypefn
7006
7007 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7008 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7009 in its second parameter.
7010 @end deftypefn
7011
7012 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7013 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7014 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7015 also the latencies of operations.
7016 @end deftypevr
7017
7018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7019 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7020 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7021 @end deftypefn
7022
7023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7024 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7025 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7026 are returned via pointer parameters.
7027
7028 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7029 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7030 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7031 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7032 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7033 should be calculated and returned.
7034
7035 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7036 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7037 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7038 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7039 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7040 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7041 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7042 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7043 instructions.
7044
7045 Given below example:
7046
7047 @smallexample
7048 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7049 add r4, r4, r10
7050 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7051 sub r5, r5, r15
7052 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7053 add r4, r4, r11
7054 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7055 sub r5, r5, r16
7056 @end smallexample
7057
7058 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7059 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7060 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7061 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7062 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7063
7064 @smallexample
7065 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7066 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7067 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7068 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7069 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7070 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7071 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7072 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7073 @end smallexample
7074
7075 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7076 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7077 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7078
7079 @smallexample
7080 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7081 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7082 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7083 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7084 add r4, r4, r10
7085 sub r5, r5, r15
7086 add r4, r4, r11
7087 sub r5, r5, r16
7088 @end smallexample
7089
7090 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7091
7092 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7093 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7094
7095 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7096 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7097 @end deftypefn
7098
7099 @node Sections
7100 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7101 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7102 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7103
7104 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7105 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7106 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7107 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7108 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7109 of sections.
7110
7111 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7112 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7113 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7114 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7115 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7116 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7117 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7118
7119 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7120 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7121 to be string literals.
7122
7123 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7124 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7125 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7126 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7127
7128 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7129 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7130 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7131 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7132 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7133 reuse @code{text_section}.
7134
7135 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7136 if the target does not provide them.
7137
7138 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7139 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7140 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7141 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7142 @end defmac
7143
7144 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7145 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7146 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7147 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7148 @end defmac
7149
7150 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7151 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7152 executed functions in the program.
7153 @end defmac
7154
7155 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7156 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7157 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7158 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7159 @end defmac
7160
7161 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7162 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7163 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7164 initialized, writable small data.
7165 @end defmac
7166
7167 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7168 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7169 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7170 data.
7171 @end defmac
7172
7173 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7174 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7175 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7176 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7177 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7178 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7179 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7180 used.
7181 @end defmac
7182
7183 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7184 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7185 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7186 uninitialized, writable small data.
7187 @end defmac
7188
7189 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7190 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7191 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7192 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7193 @end defmac
7194
7195 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7196 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7197 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7198 default is @code{'T'}.
7199 @end defmac
7200
7201 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7202 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7203 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7204 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7205 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7206 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7207 @end defmac
7208
7209 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7210 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7211 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7212 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7213 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7214 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7215 @end defmac
7216
7217 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7218 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7219 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7220 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7221 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7222 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7223 @end defmac
7224
7225 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7226 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7227 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7228 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7229 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7230 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7231 @end defmac
7232
7233 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7234 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7235 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7236 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7237 @end defmac
7238
7239 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7240 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7241 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7242 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7243 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7244 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7245 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7246 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7247 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7248 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7249 @end defmac
7250
7251 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7252 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7253 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7254 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7255 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7256 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7257 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7258 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7259 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7260 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7261 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7262 @end defmac
7263
7264 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7265 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7266 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7267 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7268 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7269 @end defmac
7270
7271 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7272 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7273 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7274 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7275 readonly data section is used.
7276
7277 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7278 @end defmac
7279
7280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7281 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7282 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7283 of its own that you need to create.
7284
7285 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7286 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7287 described below.
7288 @end deftypefn
7289
7290 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7291 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7292 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7293 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7294 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7295
7296 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7297 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7298 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7299 in read-only sections even in executables.
7300 @end deftypefn
7301
7302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7303 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7304 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7305 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7306 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7307 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7308 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7309
7310 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7311 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7312
7313 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7314 @end deftypefn
7315
7316 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7317 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7318 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7319
7320 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7321 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7322 it is unlikely to be called.
7323 @end defmac
7324
7325 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7326 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7327 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7328 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7329 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7330
7331 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7332 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7333 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7334 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7335 @end deftypefn
7336
7337 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7338 Return the readonly data section associated with
7339 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7340 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7341 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7342 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7343 otherwise.
7344 @end deftypefn
7345
7346 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7347 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7348 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7349 the string if a different section name should be used.
7350 @end deftypevr
7351
7352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7353 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7354 @end deftypefn
7355
7356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7357 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7358 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7359 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7360 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7361 in bits.
7362
7363 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7364 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7365 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7366 @end deftypefn
7367
7368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7369 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7370 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7371 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7372 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7373 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7374 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7375 returns the @var{id} provided.
7376 @end deftypefn
7377
7378 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7379 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7380 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7381 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7382
7383 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7384 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7385 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7386 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7387 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7388
7389 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7390 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7391 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7392 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7393 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7394 leave it alone.)
7395
7396 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7397 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7398 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7399 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7400 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7401 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7402
7403 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7404 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7405 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7406 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7407 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7408 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7409
7410 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7411 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7412 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7413 before overriding it.
7414 @end deftypefn
7415
7416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7417 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7418 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7419 may have added.
7420 @end deftypefn
7421
7422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7423 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7424 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7425 @end deftypefn
7426
7427 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7428 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7429 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7430 @end deftypevr
7431
7432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7433 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7434
7435 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7436 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7437 @end deftypefn
7438
7439 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7440 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7441 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7442 or executable image).
7443
7444 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7445 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7446 currently supported object file formats.
7447 @end deftypefn
7448
7449 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7450 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7451 The default value is false.
7452 @end deftypevr
7453
7454
7455 @node PIC
7456 @section Position Independent Code
7457 @cindex position independent code
7458 @cindex PIC
7459
7460 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7461 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7462 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7463 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7464 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7465 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7466 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7467 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7468 relative addresses.
7469 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7470 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7471
7472 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7473 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7474 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7475 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7476 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7477 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7478 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7479 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7480 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7481 @end defmac
7482
7483 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7484 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7485 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7486 the default is zero. Do not define
7487 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7488 @end defmac
7489
7490 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7491 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7492 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7493 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7494 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7495 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7496 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7497 position independent code.
7498 @end defmac
7499
7500 @node Assembler Format
7501 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7502
7503 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7504 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7505 instructions do.
7506
7507 @menu
7508 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7509 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7510 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7511 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7512 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7513 and termination routines.
7514 * Macros for Initialization::
7515 Specific macros that control the handling of
7516 initialization and termination routines.
7517 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7518 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7519 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7520 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7521 @end menu
7522
7523 @node File Framework
7524 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7525 @cindex assembler format
7526 @cindex output of assembler code
7527
7528 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7529 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7530
7531 @findex default_file_start
7532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7533 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7534 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7535 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7536 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7537 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7538 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7539 @end deftypefn
7540
7541 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7542 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7543 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7544 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7545 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7546 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7547 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7548 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7549
7550 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7551 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7552 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7553 @end deftypevr
7554
7555 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7556 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7557 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7558 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7559 this to be done. The default is false.
7560 @end deftypevr
7561
7562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7563 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7564 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7565 @end deftypefn
7566
7567 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7568 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7569 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7570 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7571 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7572 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7573 this function.
7574 @end deftypefun
7575
7576 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7577 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7578 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7579 nothing.
7580 @end deftypefn
7581
7582 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7583 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7584 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7585 nothing.
7586 @end deftypefn
7587
7588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7589 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7590 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7591 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7592 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7593 nothing.
7594 @end deftypefn
7595
7596 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7597 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7598 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7599 the end of the line.
7600 @end defmac
7601
7602 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7603 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7604 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7605 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7606 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7607 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7608 @end defmac
7609
7610 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7611 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7612 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7613 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7614 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7615 @end defmac
7616
7617 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7618 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7619 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7620 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7621
7622 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7623 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7624 @end defmac
7625
7626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7627 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7628
7629 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7630 @end deftypefn
7631
7632 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7633 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7634 @end deftypefn
7635
7636 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7637 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7638 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7639 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7640 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7641 of the filename using this macro.
7642 @end defmac
7643
7644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7645 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7646 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7647 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7648 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7649 this section is associated.
7650 @end deftypefn
7651
7652 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
7653 This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
7654 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
7655 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
7656 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
7657 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
7658 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
7659 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
7660 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
7661 is emitted.
7662 @end deftypefn
7663
7664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7665 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7666 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7667 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7668 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7669 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7670 (from static destructors).
7671 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7672 @end deftypefn
7673
7674 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7675 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7676 @end deftypefn
7677
7678 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7679 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7680 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7681 @end deftypevr
7682
7683 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7684 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7685 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7686 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7687 This is true on most ELF targets.
7688 @end deftypevr
7689
7690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7691 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7692 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7693 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7694 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7695
7696 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7697 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7698 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7699 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7700 @end deftypefn
7701
7702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7703 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7704 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7705 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7706 It can take the following values:
7707
7708 @table @gcctabopt
7709 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7710 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7711
7712 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7713 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7714 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7715 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7716 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7717 various different individual optimization passes.
7718
7719 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7720 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7721 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7722 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7723 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7724 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7725 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7726 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7727 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7728 switches.
7729
7730 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7731 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7732
7733 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7734 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7735 @end table
7736
7737 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7738 supported in the future.
7739
7740 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7741 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7742 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7743 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7744 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7745 hook.
7746 @end deftypefn
7747
7748 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7749 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7750 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7751 hook.
7752 @end deftypevr
7753
7754 @need 2000
7755 @node Data Output
7756 @subsection Output of Data
7757
7758
7759 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7760 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7761 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7762 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7763 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7764 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7765 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7766 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7767 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7768 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7769 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7770 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7771 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7772 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7773
7774 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7775 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7776 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7777 @end deftypevr
7778
7779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7780 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7781 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7782 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7783 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7784 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7785 split the object into smaller parts.
7786
7787 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7788 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7789 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7790 @end deftypefn
7791
7792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7793 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7794 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7795 @end deftypefn
7796
7797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7798 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7799 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7800 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7801 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7802
7803 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7804 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7805 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7806 return @code{true}.
7807 @end deftypefn
7808
7809 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7810 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7811 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7812 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7813 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7814
7815 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7816 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7817 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7821 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7822 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7823 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7824 @end defmac
7825
7826 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7827 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7828 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7829 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7830 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7831 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7832 pool before the function.
7833 @end defmac
7834
7835 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7836 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7837 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7838 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7839 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7840 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7841 immediately after this call.
7842
7843 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7844 not be defined.
7845 @end defmac
7846
7847 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7848 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7849 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7850 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7851
7852 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7853 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7854 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7855 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7856 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7857 alignment.
7858
7859 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7860 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7861 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7862 Here is how to do this:
7863
7864 @smallexample
7865 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7866 @end smallexample
7867
7868 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7869 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7870 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7871
7872 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7873 @end defmac
7874
7875 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7876 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7877 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7878 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7879 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7880 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7881
7882 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7883 define this macro.
7884 @end defmac
7885
7886 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7887 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7888 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7889 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7890 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7891
7892 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7893 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7894 @end defmac
7895
7896 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7897 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7898 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7899 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7900 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7901 @end deftypevr
7902
7903 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7904 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7905
7906 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7907 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7908 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7909 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7910 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7911 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7912 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7913 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7914 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7915 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7916 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7917 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7918 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7919 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7920 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7921 on the host machine.
7922
7923 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7924 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7925 machine's memory.
7926 @end defmac
7927
7928 @node Uninitialized Data
7929 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7930
7931 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7932 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7933
7934 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7935 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7936 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7937 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7938 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7939 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7940 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7941 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7942 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7943 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7944 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7945 an ordinary undefined external.
7946
7947 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7948 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7949 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7950
7951 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7952 common global variables are output.
7953 @end defmac
7954
7955 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7956 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7957 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7958 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7959 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7960 as the number of bits.
7961 @end defmac
7962
7963 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7964 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7965 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7966 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7967 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7968 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7969 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7970 @end defmac
7971
7972 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7974 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7975 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7976 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7977
7978 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7979 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7980 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7981 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7982 the name, and a newline.
7983
7984 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7985 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7986 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7987 You do not need to do both.
7988
7989 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7990 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7991 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7992 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7993 common in order to save space in the object file.
7994 @end defmac
7995
7996 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7997 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7998 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7999 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8000 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8001
8002 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8003 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8004 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8005
8006 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8007 static variables are output.
8008 @end defmac
8009
8010 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8011 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8012 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8013 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8014 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8015 as the number of bits.
8016 @end defmac
8017
8018 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8019 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
8020 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8021 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8022 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
8023 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8024 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8025 @end defmac
8026
8027 @node Label Output
8028 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8029
8030 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8031 This is about outputting labels.
8032
8033 @findex assemble_name
8034 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8035 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8036 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8037 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8038 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8039 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8040 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8041 @end defmac
8042
8043 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8044 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8045 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8046 a function.
8047 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8048 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8049 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8050 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8051
8052 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8053 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8054 @end defmac
8055
8056 @findex assemble_name_raw
8057 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8058 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8059 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8060 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8061 that it is more efficient.
8062 @end defmac
8063
8064 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8065 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8066 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8067 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8068 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8069
8070 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8071 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8072 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8073 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8074 define this macro.
8075 @end defmac
8076
8077 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8078 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8079 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8080 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8081 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8082 provided.
8083 @end defmac
8084
8085 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8086 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8087 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8088 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8089 address.
8090
8091 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8092 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8093 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8094 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8095 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8096 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8097 @end defmac
8098
8099 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8100 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8101 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8102 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8103 @samp{.} is used instead.
8104 @end defmac
8105
8106 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8107 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8108 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8109 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8110 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8111 @end defmac
8112
8113 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8114 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8115 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8116 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8117 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8118
8119 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8120 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8121 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8122 types at all, do not define this macro.
8123 @end defmac
8124
8125 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8126 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8127 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8128 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8129 the default is not to define this macro.
8130
8131 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8132 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8133 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8134 types at all, do not define this macro.
8135 @end defmac
8136
8137 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8138 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8139 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8140 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8141 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8142 you should not count on this.
8143
8144 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8145 definition of this macro is provided.
8146 @end defmac
8147
8148 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8149 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8150 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8151 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8152 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8153 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8154 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8155
8156 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8157 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8158
8159 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8160 of this macro.
8161 @end defmac
8162
8163 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8164 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8165 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8166 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8167 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8168 representing the function.
8169
8170 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8171
8172 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8173 of this macro.
8174 @end defmac
8175
8176 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8177 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8178 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8179 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8180 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8181 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8182 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8183
8184 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8185 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8186
8187 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8188 of this macro.
8189 @end defmac
8190
8191 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8192 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8193 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8194 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8195 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8196 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8197
8198 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8199
8200 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8201 of this macro.
8202 @end defmac
8203
8204 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8205 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8206 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8207 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8208 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8209 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8210
8211 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8212 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8213
8214 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8215 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8216 @end defmac
8217
8218 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8219 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8220 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8221 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8222 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8223 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8224 will be an internal label.
8225
8226 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8227 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8228
8229 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8230 @end deftypefn
8231
8232 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8233 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8234 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8235 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8236
8237 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8238 nothing.
8239 @end defmac
8240
8241 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8242 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8243 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8244 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8245 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8246 something about the size of the object.
8247
8248 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8249 nothing.
8250
8251 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8252 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8253 @end defmac
8254
8255 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8256 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8257 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8258 that is, available for reference from other files.
8259
8260 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8261 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8262 @end deftypefn
8263
8264 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8265 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8266 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8267 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8268
8269 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8270 @end deftypefn
8271
8272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8273 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8274 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8275 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8276 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8277 @end deftypefn
8278
8279 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8280 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8281 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8282 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8283 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8284 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8285 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8286 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8287
8288 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8289 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8290 macro.
8291 @end defmac
8292
8293 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8294 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8295 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8296 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8297 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8298 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8299 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8300 to make @var{name} weak.
8301 @end defmac
8302
8303 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8304 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8305 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8306 declaration of @code{name}.
8307 @end defmac
8308
8309 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8310 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8311 supports weak symbols.
8312
8313 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8314 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8315 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8316 @end defmac
8317
8318 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8319 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8320
8321 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8322 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8323 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8324 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8325 @end defmac
8326
8327 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8328 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8329 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8330 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8331 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8332 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8333 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8334 @end defmac
8335
8336 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8337 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8338 semantics.
8339
8340 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8341 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8342 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8343 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8344 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8345 be emitted as one-only.
8346 @end defmac
8347
8348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8349 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8350 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8351 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8352 @end deftypefn
8353
8354 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8355 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8356 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8357 The default is @code{0}.
8358
8359 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8360 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8361 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8362 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8363 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8364 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8365 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8366
8367 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8368 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8369 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8370 table of contents.
8371 @end defmac
8372
8373 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8374 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8375 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8376 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8377 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8378 declaration.
8379
8380 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8381 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8382 @end defmac
8383
8384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8385 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8386 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8387 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8388 @end deftypefn
8389
8390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8391 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8392 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8393 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8394 @end deftypefn
8395
8396 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8397 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8398 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8399 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8400 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8401 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8402 @end defmac
8403
8404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8405 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8406 @end deftypefn
8407
8408 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8409 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8410 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8411 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8412 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8413 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8414 @end defmac
8415
8416 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8417 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8418 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8419 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8420 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8421 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8422 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8423 being taken.
8424 @end defmac
8425
8426 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8427 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8428 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8429
8430 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8431 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8432 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8433
8434 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8435 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8436 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8437 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8438 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8439
8440 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8441 @end deftypefn
8442
8443 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8444 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8445 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8446 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8447 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8448 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8449 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8450 bundles.
8451
8452 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8453 used.
8454 @end defmac
8455
8456 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8457 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8458 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8459
8460 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8461 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8462 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8463
8464 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8465 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8466 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8467 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8468 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8469 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8470 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8471 @end defmac
8472
8473 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8474 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8475 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8476 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8477 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8478
8479 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8480 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8481 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8482 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8483 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8484 internal static variables in different scopes.
8485
8486 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8487 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8488 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8489 between the name and the number will suffice.
8490
8491 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8492 which is correct for most systems.
8493 @end defmac
8494
8495 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8496 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8497 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8498
8499 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8500 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8501 correct for most systems.
8502 @end defmac
8503
8504 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8505 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8506 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8507 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8508 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8509 the tree nodes are available.
8510
8511 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8512 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8513 correct for most systems.
8514 @end defmac
8515
8516 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8517 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8518 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8519 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8520 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8521 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8522 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8523 @end defmac
8524
8525 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8526 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8527 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8528 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8529 an undefined weak symbol.
8530
8531 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8532 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8533 @end defmac
8534
8535 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8536 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8537 Objective-C methods.
8538
8539 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8540 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8541 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8542 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8543
8544 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8545 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8546 systems define other ways of computing names.
8547
8548 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8549 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8550 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8551 50 characters extra.
8552
8553 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8554 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8555 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8556 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8557
8558 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8559 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8560 @end defmac
8561
8562 @node Initialization
8563 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8564 @cindex initialization routines
8565 @cindex termination routines
8566 @cindex constructors, output of
8567 @cindex destructors, output of
8568
8569 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8570 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8571 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8572 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8573 @code{main} is called.
8574
8575 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8576 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8577 terminates.
8578
8579 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8580 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8581 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8582 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8583
8584 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8585 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8586 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8587
8588 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8589 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8590 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8591 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8592 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8593
8594 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8595 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8596 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8597 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8598 pointer containing zero.
8599
8600 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8601 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8602 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8603 list; destructors in forward order.
8604
8605 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8606 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8607 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8608 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8609 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8610 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8611 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8612 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8613
8614 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8615 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8616 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8617 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8618 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8619
8620 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8621 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8622 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8623 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8624 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8628 @end smallexample
8629
8630 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8631 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8632 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8633 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8634 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8635
8636 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8637 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8638 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8639 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8640 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8641 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8642
8643 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8644 macro properly.
8645
8646 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8647 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8648 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8649 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8650 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8651 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8652
8653 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8654 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8655 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8656 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8657 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8658 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8659 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8660 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8661 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8662 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8663 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8664 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8665 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8666 the initialization process.
8667
8668 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8669 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8670 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8671 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8672 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8673 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8674 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8675 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8676 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8677 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8678 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8679
8680 @ifinfo
8681 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8682 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8683 @end ifinfo
8684
8685 @node Macros for Initialization
8686 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8687
8688 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8689 and termination functions:
8690
8691 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8692 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8693 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8694 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8695 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8696 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8697 run the initialization functions.
8698 @end defmac
8699
8700 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8701 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8702 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8703 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8704 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8705 @end defmac
8706
8707 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8708 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8709 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8710 @end defmac
8711
8712 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8713 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8714 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8715 @end defmac
8716
8717 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8718 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8719 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8720 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8721 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8722 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8723
8724 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8725 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8726 exception tables embedded in the code.
8727 @end defmac
8728
8729 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8730 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8731 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8732 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8733 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8734 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8735 @end defmac
8736
8737 @defmac INVOKE__main
8738 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8739 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8740 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8741 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8742 @end defmac
8743
8744 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8745 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8746 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8747 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8748 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8749 @end defmac
8750
8751 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8752 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8753 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8754 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8755 @end deftypevr
8756
8757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8758 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8759 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8760
8761 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8762 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8763 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8764 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8765
8766 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8767 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8768 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8769 is not defined.
8770 @end deftypefn
8771
8772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8773 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8774 functions rather than initialization functions.
8775 @end deftypefn
8776
8777 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8778 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8779
8780 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8781 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8782 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8783
8784 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8785 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8786
8787 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8788 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8789 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8790 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8791
8792 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8793 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8794 @end defmac
8795
8796 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8797 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8798 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8799 @command{nm}.
8800 @end defmac
8801
8802 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8803 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8804 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8805 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8806 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8807 produces.
8808 @end defmac
8809
8810 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8811 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8812 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8813 termination functions in shared libraries:
8814
8815 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8816 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8817 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8818 @end defmac
8819
8820 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8821 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8822 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8823 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8824 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8825 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8826 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8827 @end defmac
8828
8829 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8830 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8831 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8832 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8833 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8834 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8835 @end defmac
8836
8837 @node Instruction Output
8838 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8839
8840 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8841 This describes assembler instruction output.
8842
8843 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8844 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8845 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8846 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8847 @end defmac
8848
8849 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8850 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8851 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8852 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8853 to registers using alternate names.
8854 @end defmac
8855
8856 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8857 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8858 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8859 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8860 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8861 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8862 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8863 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8864
8865 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8866 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8867 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8868 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8869 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8870 @end defmac
8871
8872 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8873 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8874 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8875
8876 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8877 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8878 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8879 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8880 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8881 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8882 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8883 so that it will not be output twice.
8884
8885 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8886 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8887 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8888 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8889 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8890
8891 @findex recog_data.operand
8892 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8893 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8894
8895 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8896 in the usual way.
8897 @end defmac
8898
8899 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8900 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8901 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8902 they will be output differently.
8903
8904 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8905 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8906 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8907 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8908 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8909 by changing the contents of the vector.
8910
8911 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8912 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8913 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8914 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8915 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8916 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8917
8918 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8919 @end defmac
8920
8921 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8922 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8923 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8924 if necessary.
8925
8926 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8927 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8928 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8929 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8930 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8931 by checking the contents of the vector.
8932 @end deftypefn
8933
8934 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8935 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8936 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8937 RTL expression.
8938
8939 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8940 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8941 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8942 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8943 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8944 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8945 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8946
8947 @findex reg_names
8948 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8949 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8950 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8951 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8952
8953 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8954 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8955 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8956 @var{code}.
8957 @end defmac
8958
8959 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8960 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8961 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8962 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8963 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8964 in this way.
8965 @end defmac
8966
8967 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8968 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8969 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8970 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8971
8972 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8973 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8974 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8975 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8976 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8977 Format}.
8978 @end defmac
8979
8980 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8981 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8982 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8983 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8984 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8985 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8986 or whatever.
8987
8988 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8989 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8990 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8991 @end defmac
8992
8993 @findex final_sequence
8994 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8995 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8996 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8997 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8998 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8999 being output.
9000
9001 @findex asm_fprintf
9002 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9003 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9004 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9005 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9006 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9007 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9008 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9009 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9010 files can define these macros differently.
9011 @end defmac
9012
9013 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9014 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9015 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9016 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9017 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9018 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9019 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9020 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9021 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9022 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9023 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9024 @end defmac
9025
9026 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9027 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9028 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9029 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9030 first variant.
9031
9032 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9033 @smallexample
9034 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9035 @end smallexample
9036 @noindent
9037 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9038 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9039 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9040 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9041 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9042 alternatives within the braces than the value of
9043 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9044 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9045 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9046
9047 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9048 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9049 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9050
9051 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9052 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9053 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
9054 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9055 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9056 opcodes or operand order.
9057 @end defmac
9058
9059 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9060 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9061 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9062 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9063 profiling.
9064 @end defmac
9065
9066 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9067 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9068 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9069 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9070 profiling.
9071 @end defmac
9072
9073 @node Dispatch Tables
9074 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9075
9076 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9077 This concerns dispatch tables.
9078
9079 @cindex dispatch table
9080 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9081 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9082 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9083 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9084 definitions of these labels are output using
9085 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9086 way here. For example,
9087
9088 @smallexample
9089 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9090 @var{value}, @var{rel})
9091 @end smallexample
9092
9093 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9094 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
9095 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9096 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9097 mode and flags can be read.
9098 @end defmac
9099
9100 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9101 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9102 in a dispatch table are absolute.
9103
9104 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9105 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9106 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9107 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9108 For example,
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9112 @end smallexample
9113 @end defmac
9114
9115 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9116 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9117 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9118 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9119 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9120 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9121
9122 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9123 for the table.
9124
9125 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9126 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9127 @end defmac
9128
9129 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9130 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9131 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9132 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9133 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9134 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9135 of the preceding label.
9136
9137 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9138 the jump-table.
9139 @end defmac
9140
9141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9142 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9143 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9144 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9145 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9146 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9147 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9148 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9149
9150 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9151 @end deftypefn
9152
9153 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9154 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9155 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9156 to be broken up according to function.
9157
9158 The default is that no label is emitted.
9159 @end deftypefn
9160
9161 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9162 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9163 @end deftypefn
9164
9165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9166 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9167 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9168 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9169 @end deftypefn
9170
9171 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9172 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9173 @end deftypevr
9174
9175 @node Exception Region Output
9176 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9177
9178 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9179
9180 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9181 region.
9182
9183 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9184 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9185 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9186 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9187 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9188
9189 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9190 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9191 @end defmac
9192
9193 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9194 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9195 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9196 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9197
9198 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9199 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9200 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9201 be marked as not to be collected.
9202 @end defmac
9203
9204 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9205 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9206 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9207 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9208 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9209 @end defmac
9210
9211 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9212 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9213 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9214 @end defmac
9215
9216 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9217 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9218 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9219 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9220 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9221 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9222 @end defmac
9223
9224 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9225 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9226 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9227 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9228 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9229 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9230 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9231
9232 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9233 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9234 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9235
9236 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9237 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9238 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9239 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9240 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9241 depending on this setting.
9242
9243 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9244 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9245 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9246 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9247 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9248 @end deftypefn
9249
9250 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9251 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9252 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9253 command-line option processing.
9254 @end deftypevr
9255
9256 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9257 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9258 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9259 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9260 @end defmac
9261
9262 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9263 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9264 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9265 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9266 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9267 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9268 @end defmac
9269
9270 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9271 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9272 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9273 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9274 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9275 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9276 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9277 @end defmac
9278
9279 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9280 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9281 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9282 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9283 true otherwise.
9284 @end deftypevr
9285
9286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9287 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9288 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9289 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9290 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9291 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9292 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9293 @end deftypefn
9294
9295 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9296 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9297 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9298 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9299 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9300 @end deftypefn
9301
9302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9303 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9304 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9305 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9306 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9307 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9308 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9309 @end deftypefn
9310
9311 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9312 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9313 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9314 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9315 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9316 @end deftypefn
9317
9318 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9319 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9320 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9321 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9322 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9323 @end deftypevr
9324
9325 @node Alignment Output
9326 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9327
9328 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9329 This describes commands for alignment.
9330
9331 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9332 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9333 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9334
9335 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9336 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9337 define the macro.
9338
9339 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9340 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9341 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9342 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9343 @end defmac
9344
9345 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9346 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9347 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9348 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9349 @end deftypefn
9350
9351 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9352 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9353 a @code{BARRIER}.
9354
9355 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9356 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9357 define the macro.
9358 @end defmac
9359
9360 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9361 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9362 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9363 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9364 @end deftypefn
9365
9366 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9367 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9368 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9369
9370 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9371 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9372 define the macro.
9373
9374 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9375 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9376 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9377 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9378 @end defmac
9379
9380 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9381 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9382 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9383 defined.
9384 @end deftypefn
9385
9386 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9387 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9388 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9389 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9390
9391 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9392 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9393 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9394 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9395 @end defmac
9396
9397 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9398 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9399 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9400 is defined.
9401 @end deftypefn
9402
9403 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9404 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9405 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9406 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9407 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9408 @end defmac
9409
9410 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9411 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9412 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9413 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9414 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9415 section.
9416 @end defmac
9417
9418 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9419 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9420 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9421 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9422 @end defmac
9423
9424 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9425 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9426 for padding, if necessary.
9427 @end defmac
9428
9429 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9430 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9431 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9432 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9433 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9434 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9435 @end defmac
9436
9437 @need 3000
9438 @node Debugging Info
9439 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9440
9441 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9442 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9443
9444 @menu
9445 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9446 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9447 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9448 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9449 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9450 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9451 @end menu
9452
9453 @node All Debuggers
9454 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9455
9456 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9457 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9458
9459 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9460 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9461 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9462 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9463 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9464 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9465 compiler and another for DBX@.
9466
9467 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9468 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9469 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9470 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9471 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9472
9473 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9474 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9475 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9476 @end defmac
9477
9478 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9479 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9480 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9481 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9482 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9483 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9484 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9485 @option{-g} options is used.
9486 @end defmac
9487
9488 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9489 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9490 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9491 @var{offset}.
9492 @end defmac
9493
9494 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9495 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9496 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9497 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9498 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9499 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9500 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9501
9502 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9503 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9504 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9505 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9506 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9507
9508 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9509 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9510 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9511 @end defmac
9512
9513 @node DBX Options
9514 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9515
9516 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9517 These are specific options for DBX output.
9518
9519 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9520 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9521 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9522 @end defmac
9523
9524 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9525 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9526 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9527 @end defmac
9528
9529 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9530 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9531 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9532 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9533 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9534 if there is any occasion to.
9535 @end defmac
9536
9537 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9538 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9539 in the text section.
9540 @end defmac
9541
9542 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9543 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9544 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9545 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9546 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9547 @end defmac
9548
9549 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9550 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9551 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9552 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9553 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9554 information format.
9555 @end defmac
9556
9557 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9558 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9559 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9560 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9561 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9562 @end defmac
9563
9564 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9565 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9566 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9567 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9568 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9569 @end defmac
9570
9571 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9572 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9573 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9574 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9575 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9576 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9577 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9578 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9579 @end defmac
9580
9581 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9582 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9583 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9584 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9585 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9586 if backslash is correct for your system.
9587 @end defmac
9588
9589 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9590 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9591 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9592 variable.
9593 @end defmac
9594
9595 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9596 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9597 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9598 @end defmac
9599
9600 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9601 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9602 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9603 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9604 @end defmac
9605
9606 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9607 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9608 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9609 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9610 @end defmac
9611
9612 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9613 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9614 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9615 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9616 @end defmac
9617
9618 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9619 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9620 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9621 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9622 code.
9623 @end defmac
9624
9625 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9626 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9627 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9628 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9629 an absolute address.
9630 @end defmac
9631
9632 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9633 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9634 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9635 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9636 @end defmac
9637
9638 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9639 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9640 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9641 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9642 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9643 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9644 number for a type number.
9645 @end defmac
9646
9647 @node DBX Hooks
9648 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9649
9650 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9651 These are hooks for DBX format.
9652
9653 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9654 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9655 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9656 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9657 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9658 unique labels in the assembly output.
9659
9660 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9661 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9662 @end defmac
9663
9664 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9665 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9666 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9667 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9668 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9669 @end defmac
9670
9671 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9672 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9673 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9674 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9675 @end defmac
9676
9677 @node File Names and DBX
9678 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9679
9680 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9681 This describes file names in DBX format.
9682
9683 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9684 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9685 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9686 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9687 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9688
9689 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9690 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9691
9692 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9693 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9694 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9695 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9696 @end defmac
9697
9698 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9699 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9700 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9701 the beginning of the file.
9702 @end defmac
9703
9704 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9705 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9706 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9707 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9708 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9709 @end defmac
9710
9711 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9712 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9713 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9714 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9715
9716 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9717 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9718 @end defmac
9719
9720 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9721 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9722 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9723 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9724 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9725 @end defmac
9726
9727 @need 2000
9728 @node SDB and DWARF
9729 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9730
9731 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9732 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9733
9734 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9735 Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9736 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9737 @end defmac
9738
9739 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9740 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9741 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9742
9743 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9744 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9745 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9746 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9747 @end deftypefn
9748
9749 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9750 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9751 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9752 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9753 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9754 @end defmac
9755
9756 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9757 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9758 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9759 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9760 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9761 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9762 @end defmac
9763
9764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9765 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9766 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9767 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9768 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9769
9770 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9771 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9772
9773 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9774 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9775 @end deftypefn
9776
9777 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9778 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9779 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9780 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9781 @end defmac
9782
9783 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9784 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9785 @end deftypevr
9786
9787 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9788 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9789 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9790 @end deftypevr
9791
9792 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9793 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9794 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9795 @end deftypevr
9796
9797 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9798 True if register allocation and the passes
9799 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9800 targets.
9801 @end deftypevr
9802
9803 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9804 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9805 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9806 @end defmac
9807
9808 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9809 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9810 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9811 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9812 @end defmac
9813
9814 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
9815 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9816 section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
9817 an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
9818 given @var{section}.
9819 @end defmac
9820
9821 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9822 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9823 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9824 @end defmac
9825
9826 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9827 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9828 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9829 @end defmac
9830
9831 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9832 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9833 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9834 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9835 is referenced by a function.
9836 @end defmac
9837
9838 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9839 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9840 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9841 @end deftypefn
9842
9843 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9844 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9845 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9846 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9847 not define them yourself.
9848 @end defmac
9849
9850 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9851 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9852 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9853 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9854 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9855 required.
9856 @end defmac
9857
9858 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9859 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9860 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9861 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9862 it.
9863 @end defmac
9864
9865 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9866 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9867 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9868 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9869 @end defmac
9870
9871 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9872 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9873 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9874 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9875 @end defmac
9876
9877 @need 2000
9878 @node VMS Debug
9879 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9880
9881 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9882 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9883
9884 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9885 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9886 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9887 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9888 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9889 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9890 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9891 @end defmac
9892
9893 @node Floating Point
9894 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9895 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9896 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9897
9898 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9899 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9900 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9901 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9902 doing the compilation.
9903
9904 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9905 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9906 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9907 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9908 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9909 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9910 target floating point formats are identical.
9911
9912 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9913 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9914 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9915 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9916
9917 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9918 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9919 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9920 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9921 quantity.
9922 @end defmac
9923
9924 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9925 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9926 @end deftypefn
9927
9928 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9929 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9930 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9931 @end deftypefn
9932
9933 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
9934 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9935 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9936 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9937 defined by the C language for both.
9938 @end deftypefn
9939
9940 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9941 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9942 @end deftypefn
9943
9944 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9945 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9946 @end deftypefn
9947
9948 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9949 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9950 @end deftypefn
9951
9952 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9953 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9954 @end deftypefn
9955
9956 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9957 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9958 @end deftypefn
9959
9960 @node Mode Switching
9961 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9962 @cindex mode switching
9963 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9964
9965 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9966 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9967 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9968
9969 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9970 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9971 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9972 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9973 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9974 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9975 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9976
9977 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9978 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9979 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9980 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9981 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9982 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9983 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
9984 are optional.
9985 @end defmac
9986
9987 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9988 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9989 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9990 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9991 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9992 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9993 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9994 entity in question.
9995 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9996 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9997 switch is needed / supplied.
9998 @end defmac
9999
10000 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10001 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10002 @end deftypefn
10003
10004 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10005 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10006 @end deftypefn
10007
10008 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10009 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10010 @end deftypefn
10011
10012 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10013 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10014 @end deftypefn
10015
10016 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10017 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10018 @end deftypefn
10019
10020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10021 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10022 @end deftypefn
10023
10024 @node Target Attributes
10025 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10026 @cindex target attributes
10027 @cindex machine attributes
10028 @cindex attributes, target-specific
10029
10030 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10031 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10032 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10033
10034 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10035 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10036 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10037 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10038 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10039 take.
10040 @end deftypevr
10041
10042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10043 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10044 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10045 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10046 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10047 false for all machine-specific attributes.
10048 @end deftypefn
10049
10050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10051 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10052 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10053 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10054 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10055 supposed always to be compatible.
10056 @end deftypefn
10057
10058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10059 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10060 the newly defined @var{type}.
10061 @end deftypefn
10062
10063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10064 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10065 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10066 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10067 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10068 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10069 merging.
10070 @end deftypefn
10071
10072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10073 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10074 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10075 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10076 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10077 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10078 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10079 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10080
10081 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10082 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10083 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10084 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10085 will then define a function called
10086 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10087 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10088 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10089 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10090 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10091 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10092 @end deftypefn
10093
10094 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10095 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10096 @end deftypefn
10097
10098 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10099 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10100 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10101 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10102 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10103 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10104 on this implementation detail.
10105 @end defmac
10106
10107 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10108 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10109 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10110 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10111 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10112 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10113 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10114 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10115 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10116 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10117 needed.
10118 @end deftypefn
10119
10120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10121 @cindex inlining
10122 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10123 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10124 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10125 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10126 @end deftypefn
10127
10128 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10129 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10130 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10131 These function-specific options may differ
10132 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10133 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10134
10135 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10136 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10137 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10138 @end deftypefn
10139
10140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10141 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10142 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10143 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10144 @xref{Option file format}.
10145 @end deftypefn
10146
10147 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10148 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10149 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10150 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10151 @end deftypefn
10152
10153 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10154 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10155 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10156 LTO bytecode.
10157 @end deftypefn
10158
10159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10160 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10161 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10162 function-specific options.
10163 @end deftypefn
10164
10165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10166 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10167 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10168 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10169 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10170 @end deftypefn
10171
10172 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10173 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10174 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10175 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10176 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10177
10178 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10179 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10180
10181 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10182 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10183 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10184 @end deftypefn
10185
10186 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10187 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10188 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10189 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10190 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10191 different target machines.
10192 @end deftypefn
10193
10194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10195 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10196 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10197 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10198 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10199 @end deftypefn
10200
10201 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10202 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10203 @end deftypefn
10204
10205 @node Emulated TLS
10206 @section Emulating TLS
10207 @cindex Emulated TLS
10208
10209 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10210 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10211 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10212 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10213 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10214 layer.
10215
10216 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10217 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10218 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10219 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10220
10221 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10222 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10223 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10224 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10225 @end deftypevr
10226
10227 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10228 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10229 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10230 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10231 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10232 registration function to be used.
10233 @end deftypevr
10234
10235 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10236 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10237 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10238 any section.
10239 @end deftypevr
10240
10241 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10242 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10243 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10244 section.
10245 @end deftypevr
10246
10247 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10248 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10249 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10250 @end deftypevr
10251
10252 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10253 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10254 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10255 @end deftypevr
10256
10257 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10258 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10259 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10260 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10261 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10262 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10263 @end deftypefn
10264
10265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10266 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10267 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10268 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10269 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10270 @end deftypefn
10271
10272 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10273 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10274 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10275 single objects. The default is false.
10276 @end deftypevr
10277
10278 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10279 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10280 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10281 @end deftypevr
10282
10283 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10284 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10285 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10286
10287 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10288 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10289 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10290 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10291
10292 @smallexample
10293 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10294 unsigned int d;
10295
10296 d = cp0count + 3;
10297 @end smallexample
10298
10299 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10300 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10301 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10302
10303 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10304 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10305 later in the function.
10306
10307 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10308 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10309 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10310
10311 @node PCH Target
10312 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10313 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10314
10315 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10316 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10317 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10318 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10319 @end deftypefn
10320
10321 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10322 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10323 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10324 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10325 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10326
10327 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10328 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10329 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10330 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10331
10332 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10333 suitable for most targets.
10334 @end deftypefn
10335
10336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10337 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10338 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10339 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10340 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10341 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10342 @end deftypefn
10343
10344 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10345 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10346 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10347 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10348 to do anything here.
10349 @end deftypefn
10350
10351 @node C++ ABI
10352 @section C++ ABI parameters
10353 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10354
10355 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10356 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10357 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10358 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10359 @end deftypefn
10360
10361 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10362 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10363 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10364 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10365 @end deftypefn
10366
10367 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10368 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10369 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10370 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10371 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10372 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10373 @end deftypefn
10374
10375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10376 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10377 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10378 @end deftypefn
10379
10380 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10381 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10382 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10383 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10384 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10385 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10386 backend's targeted operating system.
10387 @end deftypefn
10388
10389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10390 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10391 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10392 @code{false}.
10393 @end deftypefn
10394
10395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10396 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10397 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10398 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10399 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10400 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10401 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10402 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10403 @end deftypefn
10404
10405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10406 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10407 @end deftypefn
10408
10409 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10410 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10411 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10412 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10413 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10414 unit will not be COMDAT.
10415 @end deftypefn
10416
10417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10418 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10419 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10420 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10421 @end deftypefn
10422
10423 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10424 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10425 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10426 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10427 @end deftypefn
10428
10429 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10430 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10431 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10432 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10433 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10434 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10435 @end deftypefn
10436
10437 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10438 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10439 @end deftypefn
10440
10441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10442 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10443 @end deftypefn
10444
10445 @node Named Address Spaces
10446 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10447 @cindex named address spaces
10448
10449 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10450 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10451 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10452 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10453 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10454 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10455 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10456 @code{const} type attributes.
10457
10458 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10459 pointers to the generic address space.
10460
10461 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10462 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10463 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10464 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10465 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10466 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10467 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10468 always 32 bits).
10469
10470 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10471 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10472 address space.
10473
10474 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10475 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10476 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10477 named address space #1:
10478 @smallexample
10479 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10480 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10481 @end smallexample
10482
10483 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10484 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10485 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10486 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10487 @end deftypefn
10488
10489 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10490 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10491 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10492 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10493 @end deftypefn
10494
10495 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10496 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10497 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10498 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10499 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10500 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10501 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10502 target hooks for the given address space.
10503 @end deftypefn
10504
10505 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10506 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10507 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10508 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10509 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10510 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10511 explicit named address space support.
10512 @end deftypefn
10513
10514 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10515 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10516 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10517 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10518 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10519 @end deftypefn
10520
10521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10522 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10523 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10524 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10525 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10526 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10527 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10528 @end deftypefn
10529
10530 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10531 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10532 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10533 @end deftypefn
10534
10535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10536 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10537 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10538 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10539 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10540 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10541 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10542 @end deftypefn
10543
10544 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10545 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10546 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10547 @end deftypefn
10548
10549 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10550 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10551 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10552 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10553 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10554 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10555 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10556 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10557 The default implementation does nothing.
10558 @end deftypefn
10559
10560 @node Misc
10561 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10562 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10563
10564 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10565 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10566
10567 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10568 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10569 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10570 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10571 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10572 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10573 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10574 @end defmac
10575
10576 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10577 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10578 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10579 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10580 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10581 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10582 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10583 @end defmac
10584
10585 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10586 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10587 elements of a jump-table should have.
10588 @end defmac
10589
10590 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10591 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10592 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10593 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10594 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10595 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10596 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10597 flags can be updated.
10598 @end defmac
10599
10600 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10601 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10602 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10603 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10604 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10605 is in effect.
10606 @end defmac
10607
10608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10609 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10610 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10611 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10612 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10613 @end deftypefn
10614
10615 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10616 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10617 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10618 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10619 @end defmac
10620
10621 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10622 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10623 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10624 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10625 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10626 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10627 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10628 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10629
10630 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10631 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10632 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10633 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10634 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10635
10636 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10637 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10638 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10639 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10640 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10641
10642 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10643 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10644 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10645 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10646 @end defmac
10647
10648 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10649 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10650 extends.
10651 @end defmac
10652
10653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10654 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10655 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10656 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10657 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10658 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10659 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10660 @end deftypefn
10661
10662 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10663 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10664 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10665 @end defmac
10666
10667 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10668 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10669 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10670 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10671 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10672 at run-time.
10673 @end defmac
10674
10675 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10676 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10677 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10678 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10679 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10680 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10681 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10682 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10683 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10684 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10685 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10686
10687 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10688 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10689 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10690
10691 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10692 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10693 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10694 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10695 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10696
10697 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10698 @end defmac
10699
10700 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10702 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10703 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10704 @xref{shift patterns}.
10705
10706 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10707 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10708 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10709 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10710 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10711 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10712
10713 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10714 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10715 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10716
10717 The default implementation of this function returns
10718 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10719 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10720 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10721 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10722 by overriding it.
10723 @end deftypefn
10724
10725 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10726 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10727 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10728 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10729 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10730
10731 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10732
10733 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10734 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10735 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10736 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10737 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10738 such cases may improve things.
10739 @end defmac
10740
10741 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10742 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10743 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10744 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10745 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10746 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10747 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10748 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10749 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10750 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10751 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10752
10753 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10754 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10755 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10756 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10757
10758 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10759 describe two related properties. If you define
10760 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10761 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10762 extension.
10763
10764 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10765 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10766 @code{mode}.
10767 @end deftypefn
10768
10769 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10770 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10771 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10772 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10773 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10774 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10775
10776 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10777 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10778 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10779 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10780 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10781 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10782 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10783 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10784 the compiler.
10785
10786 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10787 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10788 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10789 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10790 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10791 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10792 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10793 expression
10794
10795 @smallexample
10796 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10797 @end smallexample
10798
10799 @noindent
10800 can be converted to
10801
10802 @smallexample
10803 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10804 @end smallexample
10805
10806 @noindent
10807 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10808 tested into the sign bit.
10809
10810 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10811 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10812 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10813 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10814 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10815 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10816
10817 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10818 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10819 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10820 to be used:
10821
10822 @itemize @bullet
10823 @item
10824 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10825 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10826 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10827 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10828 combine the normalization with other operations.
10829
10830 @item
10831 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10832 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10833 other machines.
10834
10835 @item
10836 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10837 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10838 others.
10839
10840 @item
10841 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10842 @end itemize
10843
10844 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10845 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10846 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10847 those cases, e.g., one matching
10848
10849 @smallexample
10850 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10851 @end smallexample
10852
10853 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10854 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10855 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10856 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10857 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10858 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10859 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10860 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10861
10862 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10863 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10864 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10865 @end defmac
10866
10867 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10868 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10869 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10870 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10871 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10872 this macro.
10873 @end defmac
10874
10875 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10876 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10877 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10878 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10879 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10880 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10881 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10882 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10883 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10884 given mode.
10885 @end defmac
10886
10887 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10888 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10889 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10890 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10891 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10892 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10893 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10894 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10895 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10896 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10897 this value.
10898
10899 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10900 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10901
10902 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10903 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10904 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10905 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10906
10907 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10908 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10909 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10910 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10911 breaking the API@.
10912 @end defmac
10913
10914 @defmac Pmode
10915 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10916 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10917 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10918 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10919 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10920
10921 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10922 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10923 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10924 to @code{Pmode}.
10925 @end defmac
10926
10927 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10928 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10929 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10930 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10931 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10932 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10933 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10934 @end defmac
10935
10936 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10937 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10938 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10939 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10940 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10941 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10942
10943 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10944 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10945 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10946 @end defmac
10947
10948 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10949 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10950
10951 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10952 @end deftypefn
10953
10954 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10955 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10956 @end deftypefn
10957
10958 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10959 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10960 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10961 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10962 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10963 @end defmac
10964
10965 @findex #pragma
10966 @findex pragma
10967 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10968 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10969 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10970 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10971 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10972 setup required for the pragmas.
10973
10974 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10975 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10976 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10977
10978 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10979 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10980
10981 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10982 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10983 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10984 @end defmac
10985
10986 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10987 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10988
10989 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10990 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10991 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10992 pragma of the form
10993
10994 @smallexample
10995 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10996 @end smallexample
10997
10998 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10999 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11000 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11001 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
11002 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
11003 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
11004 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11005 arguments of pragmas registered with
11006 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11007 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11008
11009 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11010 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11011 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11012 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11013 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
11014 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11015 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
11016 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11017 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
11018 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11019 how to build this object file.
11020 @end deftypefun
11021
11022 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11023 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11024 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11025 @end defmac
11026
11027 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11028 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11029 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11030 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11031 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11032 @end defmac
11033
11034 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11035 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11036 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
11037 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11038 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11039 @end defmac
11040
11041 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11042 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11043 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11044 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11045 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11046 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11047 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11048 you should define this macro.
11049
11050 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11051 @end defmac
11052
11053 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11054 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11055 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11056 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11057 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11058 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11059 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11060 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11061 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11062 slot of @var{insn}.
11063
11064 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11065 @end defmac
11066
11067 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11068 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11069 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11070 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11071 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11072 from shared libraries (DLLs).
11073
11074 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11075 @end defmac
11076
11077 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11078 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11079 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11080 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11081 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11082
11083 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11084 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11085 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11086 @end deftypefn
11087
11088 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11089 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11090 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11091 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
11092 separate math library.
11093
11094 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11095 @end defmac
11096
11097 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11098 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11099 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11100
11101 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11102 is wrong.
11103 @end defmac
11104
11105 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11106 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11107 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11108 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11109 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11110 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11111 for cross-profiling.
11112 @end defmac
11113
11114 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11115
11116 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11117 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11118 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11119 1 if it does use cc0.
11120 @end defmac
11121
11122 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11123 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11124 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11125 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11126 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11127 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11128 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11129 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11130 @end defmac
11131
11132 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11133 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11134 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11135 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11136 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11137 @end defmac
11138
11139 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11140 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11141 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11142 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11143 about the currently processed blocks.
11144 @end defmac
11145
11146 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11147 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11148 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11149 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11150 to by @var{ce_info}.
11151 @end defmac
11152
11153 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11154 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11155 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11156 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11157 to by @var{ce_info}.
11158 @end defmac
11159
11160 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11161 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11162 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11163 to by @var{ce_info}.
11164 @end defmac
11165
11166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11167 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11168 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11169 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11170
11171 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11172 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11173 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11174 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11175
11176 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11177 definition is null.
11178 @end deftypefn
11179
11180 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11181 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11182 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11183 necessary setup.
11184
11185 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11186 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11187 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11188 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11189
11190 To create a built-in function, call the function
11191 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11192 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11193 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11194 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11195 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11196 @end deftypefn
11197
11198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11199 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11200 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11201 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11202 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11203 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11204 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11205 @code{error_mark_node}.
11206 @end deftypefn
11207
11208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11209
11210 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11211 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11212 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11213 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11214 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11215 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11216 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11217 built-in function.
11218 @end deftypefn
11219
11220 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11221 This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11222 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11223 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11224 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11225 obtained using this hook:
11226 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11227 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11228 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11229 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11230 @end deftypefn
11231
11232 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11233 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11234 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11235 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11236 @end deftypefn
11237
11238 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11239 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11240 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11241 address @var{loc}.
11242 @end deftypefn
11243
11244 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11245 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11246 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11247 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11248 @end deftypefn
11249
11250 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11251 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11252 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11253 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11254 @end deftypefn
11255
11256 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11257 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11258 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11259 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11260 @end deftypefn
11261
11262 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11263 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11264 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11265 @end deftypefn
11266
11267 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11268 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11269 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11270 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11271 @end deftypefn
11272
11273 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11274 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11275 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11276 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11277 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11278 (e.g. object has incomplete type).
11279 @end deftypefn
11280
11281 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11282 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11283 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11284 @end deftypefn
11285
11286 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11287 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11288 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11289 @end deftypefn
11290 @end deftypefn
11291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11292 Return type to be used for bounds
11293 @end deftypefn
11294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11295 Return mode to be used for bounds.
11296 @end deftypefn
11297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11298 Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11299 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11300 @end deftypefn
11301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11302 Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11303 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11304 the number of generated statements.
11305 @end deftypefn
11306
11307 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11308 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11309 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11310 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11311 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11312 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11313 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11314 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11315 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11316 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11317 @end deftypefn
11318
11319 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11320 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11321 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11322 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11323 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11324 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11325 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11326 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11327 @end deftypefn
11328
11329 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11330 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11331 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11332 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11333 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11334 @end deftypefn
11335
11336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11337 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11338 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11339 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11340 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11341 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11342 the two function decls that will be compared.
11343 @end deftypefn
11344
11345 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11346 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11347 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11348 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11349 identical versions.
11350 @end deftypefn
11351
11352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11353 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11354 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11355 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11356 body must be generated.
11357 @end deftypefn
11358
11359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11360 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11361 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11362 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11363 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11364 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11365 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11366 loop is only entered from the top.
11367
11368 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11369 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11370 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11371 @end deftypefn
11372
11373 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11374
11375 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11376 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11377 could not be applied.
11378
11379 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11380 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11381 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11382 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11383 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11384 @end deftypefn
11385
11386 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11387 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11388 @end deftypefn
11389
11390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11391 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11392 @end deftypefn
11393
11394 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11395 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11396 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11397 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11398 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11399 @end deftypefn
11400
11401 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11402
11403 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11404 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11405 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11406 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11407 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11408 that had its initial value copied by using
11409 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11410 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11411 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11412 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11413 @code{MEM}.
11414 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11415 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11416 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11417 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11418 register in question will not be clobbered.
11419 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11420 allocation.
11421 @end deftypefn
11422
11423 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11424 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11425 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11426 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11427 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11428 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11429 passed along.
11430 @end deftypefn
11431
11432 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11433 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11434 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11435 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11436 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11437 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11438 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11439 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11440 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11441 The default hook function does nothing.
11442
11443 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11444 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11445 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11446 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11447 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11448 outside of any function scope.
11449 @end deftypefn
11450
11451 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11452 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11453 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11454 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11455 @end defmac
11456
11457 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11458 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11459 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11460 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11461 executable files.
11462 @end defmac
11463
11464 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11465 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11466 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11467 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11468 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11469 lists.
11470 @end defmac
11471
11472 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11473 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11474 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11475 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11476 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11477 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11478 defined as this expression:
11479
11480 @smallexample
11481 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11482 build_tree_list
11483 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11484 NULL))
11485 @end smallexample
11486 @end defmac
11487
11488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11489 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11490 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11491 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11492 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11493
11494 @smallexample
11495 static bool
11496 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11497 @{
11498 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11499 @}
11500 @end smallexample
11501 @end deftypefn
11502
11503 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11504 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11505 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11506 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11507 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11508 to inter-block scheduling.
11509 @end deftypefn
11510
11511 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11512 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11513 registers
11514 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11515 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11516 that all target registers in the class returned by
11517 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11518 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11519 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11520 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11521 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11522 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11523 @end deftypefn
11524
11525 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11526 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11527 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11528 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11529 @end deftypefn
11530
11531 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11532 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11533 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11534 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11535 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11536 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11537 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11538 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11539 @end deftypefn
11540
11541 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11542 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11543 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11544 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11545 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11546 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11547 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11548 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11549 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11550 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11551 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11552 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11553 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11554 @end deftypefn
11555
11556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11557 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11558 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11559 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11560 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11561 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11562 number of memory accesses.
11563 @end deftypefn
11564
11565 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11566 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11567 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11568 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11569 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11570 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11571 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11572 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11573 @end defmac
11574
11575 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11576 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11577 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11578 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11579 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11580 @end deftypefn
11581
11582 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11583 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11584 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11585 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11586 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11587 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11588 @end deftypefn
11589
11590 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11591 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11592 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11593 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11594 that are different from @option{-I}.
11595 @end deftypefn
11596
11597 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11598 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11599 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11600 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11601 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11602 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11603 @end defmac
11604
11605 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11606 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11607 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11608 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11609 @end defmac
11610
11611 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11612 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11613 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11614 @end defmac
11615
11616 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11617 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11618 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11619 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11620 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11621 @end defmac
11622
11623 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11624 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11625 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11626 @end defmac
11627
11628 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11629 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11630 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11631 and scanf formatter settings.
11632 @end defmac
11633
11634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11635 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11636 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11637 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11638 @end deftypefn
11639
11640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11641 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11642 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11643 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11644 @end deftypefn
11645
11646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11647 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11648 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11649 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11650 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11651 @end deftypefn
11652
11653 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11654 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11655 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11656 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11657 the front end.
11658 @end deftypefn
11659
11660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11661 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11662 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11663 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11664 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11665 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11666 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11667 @end deftypefn
11668
11669 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11670 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11671 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11672 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11673 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11674 conversion rules.
11675 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11676 @end deftypefn
11677
11678 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11679 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11680 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11681 @end defmac
11682
11683 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11684 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11685 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11686 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11687 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11688 @end defmac
11689
11690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11691 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11692 necessary.
11693 @end deftypefn
11694
11695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11696 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11697 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11698 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11699 is needed.
11700 @end deftypefn
11701
11702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11703 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11704 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11705 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11706 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11707 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11708 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11709 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11710 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11711 @end deftypefn
11712
11713 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11714 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11715 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11716 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11717 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11718 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11719 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11720 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11721 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11722 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11723 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11724 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11725 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11726 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11727 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11728 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11729 @end deftypevr
11730
11731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11732 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11733 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11734 supported by the target.
11735 @end deftypefn
11736
11737 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11738 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11739 memory model bits are allowed.
11740 @end deftypefn
11741
11742 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11743 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11744 @end deftypevr
11745
11746 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11747 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11748 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11749 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11750 @end deftypefn
11751
11752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11753 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11754 @end deftypefn
11755
11756 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11757 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11758 @end deftypefn
11759
11760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11761 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11762 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11763 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11764 @end deftypefn
11765
11766 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11767 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11768 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11769 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11770 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11771 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11772
11773 @end deftypefn
11774
11775 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11776
11777 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11778 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11779 to indicate that large integers are stored in
11780 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11781 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11782 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11783 representation.
11784
11785 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11786 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11787 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11788 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11789 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11790
11791 @itemize @bullet
11792 @item
11793 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11794 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11795 language since there are a variable number of elements.
11796
11797 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11798 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11799 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11800 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11801 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11802 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11803 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11804 not really a large change.
11805
11806 @item
11807 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11808 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11809 port in this code.
11810
11811 @item
11812 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11813 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11814 @end itemize
11815
11816 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11817 maintainer is familiar with.
11818
11819 @end defmac